blob: 9a7c0e37a165ff459a7996fbc52a592aa463a693 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau37242fa2010-08-28 19:21:00 +02007 2010/08/28
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020050
514. Proxies
524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
534.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
54
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100555. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
576. HTTP header manipulation
58
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100597. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200607.1. Matching integers
617.2. Matching strings
627.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
637.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
647.5. Available matching criteria
657.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
667.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
677.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
687.6. Pre-defined ACLs
697.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100707.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
728. Logging
738.1. Log levels
748.2. Log formats
758.2.1. Default log format
768.2.2. TCP log format
778.2.3. HTTP log format
788.3. Advanced logging options
798.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
808.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
818.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
828.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
838.4. Timing events
848.5. Session state at disconnection
858.6. Non-printable characters
868.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
878.8. Capturing HTTP headers
888.9. Examples of logs
89
909. Statistics and monitoring
919.1. CSV format
929.2. Unix Socket commands
93
94
951. Quick reminder about HTTP
96----------------------------
97
98When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
99fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
100on almost anything found in the contents.
101
102However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
103formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
104correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
105
106
1071.1. The HTTP transaction model
108-------------------------------
109
110The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100111to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
113connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
114will involve a new connection :
115
116 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
117
118In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
119establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
120by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
121length.
122
123Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
124to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
125however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
126response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
127header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
128
129 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
130
131Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
132power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
133but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200134a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
136A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
137keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
138second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
139page :
140
141 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
142
143This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
144latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
145correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
146the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100147server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
150connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
151everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
152established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
153sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
154while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
155another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
156sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
157http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
158mode.
159
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160
1611.2. HTTP request
162-----------------
163
164First, let's consider this HTTP request :
165
166 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100167 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
169 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
170 3 User-agent: my small browser
171 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
172 5 Accept: image/png
173
174
1751.2.1. The Request line
176-----------------------
177
178Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
179
180 - a METHOD : GET
181 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
182 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
183
184All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
185which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
186followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
187is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
188desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
189the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
190
191The URI itself can have several forms :
192
193 - A "relative URI" :
194
195 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
196
197 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
198 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
199
200 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
201
202 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
203
204 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
205 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
206 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
207 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
208 must accept this form too.
209
210 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
211 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
212 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
215 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
216 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
217 other protocols too.
218
219In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
220mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
221on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
222It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
223specific to the language, framework or application in use.
224
225
2261.2.2. The request headers
227--------------------------
228
229The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
230beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
231an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
232Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
233values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
234encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
235the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
236define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
237
238Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
239their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
240"Connection:" header).
241
242The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
243that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
244is one valid form of empty line.
245
246Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
247headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
248about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
249application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
250
251Important note:
252 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
253 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
254 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
255 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
256
257
2581.3. HTTP response
259------------------
260
261An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
262messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
263
264 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
267 2 Content-length: 350
268 3 Content-Type: text/html
269
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200270As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
271codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
272response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100273continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
274the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
275following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
276sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
277(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
278correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
279such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
280state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
281over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
282if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
283information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285
2861.3.1. The Response line
287------------------------
288
289Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
290
291 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
292 - a status code : 200
293 - a reason : OK
294
295The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
298 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
299 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
300 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
301
302Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100303"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
305messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
306or "Authentication Required".
307
308Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
309
310 Code When / reason
311 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
312 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
313 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
314 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 400 for an invalid or too large request
316 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
317 accessing the stats page)
318 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
319 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
320 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
321 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
322 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
323 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
324 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
325 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
326 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
327
328The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3294.2).
330
331
3321.3.2. The response headers
333---------------------------
334
335Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
336the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
337details.
338
339
3402. Configuring HAProxy
341----------------------
342
3432.1. Configuration file format
344------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200345
346HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
347
348 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
349 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
350 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
351 "frontend" and "backend".
352
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100353The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
354referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
355delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100356preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357escaped by doubling them.
358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
3602.2. Time format
361----------------
362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100363Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
365otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
366numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
367for every keyword. Supported units are :
368
369 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
370 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
371 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
372 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
373 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
374 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
375
376
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003772.3. Examples
378-------------
379
380 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
381 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
382 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
383 global
384 daemon
385 maxconn 256
386
387 defaults
388 mode http
389 timeout connect 5000ms
390 timeout client 50000ms
391 timeout server 50000ms
392
393 frontend http-in
394 bind *:80
395 default_backend servers
396
397 backend servers
398 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
399
400
401 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
402 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
403 global
404 daemon
405 maxconn 256
406
407 defaults
408 mode http
409 timeout connect 5000ms
410 timeout client 50000ms
411 timeout server 50000ms
412
413 listen http-in
414 bind *:80
415 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
416
417
418Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
419
420 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -d
421
422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004233. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200424--------------------
425
426Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
427are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
428of them have command-line equivalents.
429
430The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
431
432 * Process management and security
433 - chroot
434 - daemon
435 - gid
436 - group
437 - log
438 - nbproc
439 - pidfile
440 - uid
441 - ulimit-n
442 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200443 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200444 - node
445 - description
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100446
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200447 * Performance tuning
448 - maxconn
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100449 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - noepoll
451 - nokqueue
452 - nopoll
453 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100454 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200455 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200456 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100457 - tune.maxaccept
458 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200459 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100460 - tune.rcvbuf.client
461 - tune.rcvbuf.server
462 - tune.sndbuf.client
463 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100464
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200465 * Debugging
466 - debug
467 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468
469
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004703.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200471------------------------------------
472
473chroot <jail dir>
474 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
475 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
476 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
477 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
478 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
479 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100480
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200481daemon
482 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
483 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
484 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
485
486gid <number>
487 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
488 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
489 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
490 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100491
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200492group <group name>
493 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
494 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100495
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200496log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200497 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
498 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100499 configured with "log global".
500
501 <address> can be one of:
502
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100503 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100504 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
505 port).
506
507 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
508 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
509 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
510 writeable).
511
512 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200513
514 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
515 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
516 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
517
518 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200519 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
520 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
521 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
522 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
523 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
524 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200525
526 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
527
528nbproc <number>
529 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
530 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
531 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
532 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
533 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
534
535pidfile <pidfile>
536 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
537 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
538 starting the process. See also "daemon".
539
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200540stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200541 [level <level>]
542
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200543 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
544 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100545 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200546 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
547
548 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
549 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
550 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
551 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
552 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
553
554 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
555 be read, and only non-sensible changes are permitted (eg: clear max
556 counters).
557
558 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
559 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100560
561 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
562 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
563 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
564 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
565 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
566 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
567 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200568
569stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
570 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
571 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100572 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200573
574stats maxconn <connections>
575 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
576 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
577
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200578uid <number>
579 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
580 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
581 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
582 one. See also "gid" and "user".
583
584ulimit-n <number>
585 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
586 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
587 option.
588
589user <user name>
590 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
591 See also "uid" and "group".
592
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200593node <name>
594 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
595
596 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
597 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
598 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
599 traffic.
600
601description <text>
602 Add a text that describes the instance.
603
604 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
605 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
606 "<" and ">" characters.
607
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006093.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610-----------------------
611
612maxconn <number>
613 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
614 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
615 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
616 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
617
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100618maxpipes <number>
619 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
620 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
621 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
622 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
623 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
624 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
625
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200626noepoll
627 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
628 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
629 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
630
631nokqueue
632 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
633 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
634 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
635
636nopoll
637 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
638 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100639 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200640 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
641 "nokqueue".
642
643nosepoll
644 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
645 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
646 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
647
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100648nosplice
649 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
650 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
651 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100652 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100653 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
654 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
655 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
656 "option splice-response".
657
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200658spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
659 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
660 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
661 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
662 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
663 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
664
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200665tune.bufsize <number>
666 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
667 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
668 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
669 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
670 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
671 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
672 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
673 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
674
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100675tune.maxaccept <number>
676 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
677 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
678 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100679 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100680 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
681 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100682 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100683 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
684
685tune.maxpollevents <number>
686 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
687 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
688 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
689 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
690 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
691
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200692tune.maxrewrite <number>
693 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
694 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
695 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
696 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
697 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
698 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
699 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
700 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
701 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
702 bufsize.
703
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100704tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
705tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
706 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
707 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
708 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
709 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
710 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
711 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
712 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
713
714tune.sndbuf.client <number>
715tune.sndbuf.server <number>
716 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
717 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
718 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
719 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
720 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
721 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
722 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
723 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
724 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
725 notifying haproxy again.
726
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200727
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007283.3. Debugging
729--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200730
731debug
732 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
733 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
734 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
735 system startup.
736
737quiet
738 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
739 line argument "-q".
740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007413.4. Userlists
742--------------
743It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
744http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
745it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
746
747userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100748 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100749 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
750
751group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100752 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100753 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
754 proceeded by "users" keyword.
755
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100756user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
757 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100758 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
759 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100760 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
761 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100762 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
763 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
764
765
766 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100767 userlist L1
768 group G1 users tiger,scott
769 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100770
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100771 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
772 user scott insecure-password elgato
773 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100774
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100775 userlist L2
776 group G1
777 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100778
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100779 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
780 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
781 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100782
783 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200784
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007854. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200786----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100787
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200788Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
789 - defaults <name>
790 - frontend <name>
791 - backend <name>
792 - listen <name>
793
794A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
795its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
796section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100797section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200798
799A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
800connections.
801
802A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
803to forward incoming connections.
804
805A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
806parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
807
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100808All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
809'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
810case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
811
812Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
813logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
814proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
815However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
816name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
817
818Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
819and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100820bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100821protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
822modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
823arbitrary criteria.
824
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100825
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008264.1. Proxy keywords matrix
827--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100828
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200829The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
830limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
831they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
832limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100833marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200834option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200835and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
836with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
837specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100838
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200839
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100840 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
841------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
842acl - X X X
843appsession - - X X
844backlog X X X -
845balance X - X X
846bind - X X -
847bind-process X X X X
848block - X X X
849capture cookie - X X -
850capture request header - X X -
851capture response header - X X -
852clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
853contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
854cookie X - X X
855default-server X - X X
856default_backend X X X -
857description - X X X
858disabled X X X X
859dispatch - - X X
860enabled X X X X
861errorfile X X X X
862errorloc X X X X
863errorloc302 X X X X
864-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
865errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200866force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100867fullconn X - X X
868grace X X X X
869hash-type X - X X
870http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100871http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200872http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100873http-request - X X X
874id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200875ignore-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100876log X X X X
877maxconn X X X -
878mode X X X X
879monitor fail - X X -
880monitor-net X X X -
881monitor-uri X X X -
882option abortonclose (*) X - X X
883option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
884option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
885option allbackups (*) X - X X
886option checkcache (*) X - X X
887option clitcpka (*) X X X -
888option contstats (*) X X X -
889option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
890option dontlognull (*) X X X -
891option forceclose (*) X X X X
892-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
893option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200894option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100895option http-server-close (*) X X X X
896option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
897option httpchk X - X X
898option httpclose (*) X X X X
899option httplog X X X X
900option http_proxy (*) X X X X
901option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +0200902option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100903option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
904option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
905option logasap (*) X X X -
906option mysql-check X - X X
907option nolinger (*) X X X X
908option originalto X X X X
909option persist (*) X - X X
910option redispatch (*) X - X X
911option smtpchk X - X X
912option socket-stats (*) X X X -
913option splice-auto (*) X X X X
914option splice-request (*) X X X X
915option splice-response (*) X X X X
916option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
917option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
918-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
919option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
920option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
921option tcpka X X X X
922option tcplog X X X X
923option transparent (*) X - X X
924persist rdp-cookie X - X X
925rate-limit sessions X X X -
926redirect - X X X
927redisp (deprecated) X - X X
928redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
929reqadd - X X X
930reqallow - X X X
931reqdel - X X X
932reqdeny - X X X
933reqiallow - X X X
934reqidel - X X X
935reqideny - X X X
936reqipass - X X X
937reqirep - X X X
938reqisetbe - X X X
939reqitarpit - X X X
940reqpass - X X X
941reqrep - X X X
942-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
943reqsetbe - X X X
944reqtarpit - X X X
945retries X - X X
946rspadd - X X X
947rspdel - X X X
948rspdeny - X X X
949rspidel - X X X
950rspideny - X X X
951rspirep - X X X
952rsprep - X X X
953server - - X X
954source X - X X
955srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
956stats auth X - X X
957stats enable X - X X
958stats hide-version X - X X
959stats realm X - X X
960stats refresh X - X X
961stats scope X - X X
962stats show-desc X - X X
963stats show-legends X - X X
964stats show-node X - X X
965stats uri X - X X
966-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
967stick match - - X X
968stick on - - X X
969stick store-request - - X X
970stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200971tcp-request connection - X X -
972tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +0200973tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100974timeout check X - X X
975timeout client X X X -
976timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
977timeout connect X - X X
978timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
979timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
980timeout http-request X X X X
981timeout queue X - X X
982timeout server X - X X
983timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
984timeout tarpit X X X X
985transparent (deprecated) X - X X
986use_backend - X X -
987------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
988 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200989
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100990
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009914.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
992---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100993
994This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
995
996
997acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
998 Declare or complete an access list.
999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1000 no | yes | yes | yes
1001 Example:
1002 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1003 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1004 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001006 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001007
1008
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001009appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1010 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001011 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1013 no | no | yes | yes
1014 Arguments :
1015 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1016 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1017
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001018 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001019 checked in each cookie value.
1020
1021 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1022 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1023 milliseconds.
1024
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001025 request-learn
1026 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1027 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1028 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1029 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1030 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1031 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1032
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001033 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1034 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1035 data following this prefix.
1036
1037 Example :
1038 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1039
1040 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1041 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1042
1043 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1044 2 modes are currently supported :
1045 - path-parameters :
1046 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1047 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1048 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1049 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1050 - query-string :
1051 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1052 query string.
1053
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001054 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1055 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1056 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1057 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001058 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1059 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1060 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001061 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1062 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1063
1064 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1065
1066 Example :
1067 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1068
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001069 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001070 and "ignore-persist"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001071
1072
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001073backlog <conns>
1074 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1076 yes | yes | yes | no
1077 Arguments :
1078 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1079 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
1080 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
1081
1082 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1083 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1084 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1085 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1086 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1087 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1088 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1089 backlog parameter.
1090
1091 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1092 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1093 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1094
1095 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1096
1097
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001098balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001099balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001100 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1102 yes | no | yes | yes
1103 Arguments :
1104 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1105 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1106 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1107 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1108
1109 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1110 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1111 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1112 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001113 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1114 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1115 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1116 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1117 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1118 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1119 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1120 it, so that you don't worry.
1121
1122 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1123 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1124 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1125 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1126 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1127 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1128 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1129 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001130
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001131 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1132 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1133 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1134 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1135 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1136 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1137 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1138 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1139
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001140 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1141 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1142 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1143 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1144 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1145 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1146 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1147 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001148 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001149 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001150 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1151 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1152 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001153
1154 uri The left part of the URI (before the question mark) is hashed
1155 and divided by the total weight of the running servers. The
1156 result designates which server will receive the request. This
1157 ensures that a same URI will always be directed to the same
1158 server as long as no server goes up or down. This is used
1159 with proxy caches and anti-virus proxies in order to maximize
1160 the cache hit rate. Note that this algorithm may only be used
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001161 in an HTTP backend. This algorithm is static by default,
1162 which means that changing a server's weight on the fly will
1163 have no effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001164
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001165 This algorithm support two optional parameters "len" and
1166 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1167 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1168 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1169 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1170 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1171 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1172 URIs start with a leading "/".
1173
1174 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1175 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1176 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1177 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1178
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001179 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001180 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1181
1182 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
1183 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1184 when the question mark indicating a query string ('?') is not
1185 present in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1186 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1187 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1188 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1189 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1190 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1191 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1192 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1193 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1194 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1195 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1196 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1197 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1198 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1199 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1200 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1201 be randomly balanced if at all.
1202
1203 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1204 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1205 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1206 server will receive the request.
1207
1208 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1209 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1210 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1211 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1212 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001213 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1214 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1215 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001216
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001217 hdr(name) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP request.
1218 Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function, the header
1219 name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the header is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001220 absent or if it does not contain any value, the roundrobin
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001221 algorithm is applied instead.
1222
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001223 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001224 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1225 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1226 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1227
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001228 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1229 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1230 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1231
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001232 rdp-cookie
1233 rdp-cookie(name)
1234 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1235 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1236 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1237 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1238 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1239 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001240 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001241 used instead.
1242
1243 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1244 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1245 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1246 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1247
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001248 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1249 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1250 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1251
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001252 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001253 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1254 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001255
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001256 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001257 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001258
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001259 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1260 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1261 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001262
1263 Examples :
1264 balance roundrobin
1265 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001266 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001267 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1268 balance hdr(host)
1269 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001270
1271 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1272 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1273
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001274 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001275 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1276 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1277 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1278 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1279
1280 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1281 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1282 defaults to 16 kB.
1283
1284 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1285 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1286
1287 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1288 Round Robin.
1289
1290 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1291 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1292 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1293 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1294
1295 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1296
1297 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001298 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001299 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1300 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1301 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001302
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001303 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1304 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001305
1306
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001307bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1308bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1309bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1310bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1311bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1312bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1313bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001314 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1316 no | yes | yes | no
1317 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001318 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1319 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1320 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1321 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
1322 special address "0.0.0.0".
1323
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001324 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1325 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
1326 above. The port is mandatory. Note that in the case of an
1327 IPv6 address, the port is always the number after the last
1328 colon (':'). A range can either be :
1329 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1330 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1331 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1332 the range.
1333
1334 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1335 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1336 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1337 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1338 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1339 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1340 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1341 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1342 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001343
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001344 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1345 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1346 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1347 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1348 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1349 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1350 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1351 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
1352 privileges.
1353
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001354 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1355 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1356 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1357 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1358 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1359 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
1360 work on other operating systems. The commonly advertised
1361 value on Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP).
1362
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001363 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1364 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1365 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1366 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001367
1368 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1369
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001370 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1371 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1372 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001373 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001374 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1375 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1376 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1377 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
1378 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001379
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001380 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001381 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1382 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1383 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1384 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1385 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1386 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1387 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1388 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1389 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1390 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1391 with front firewalls which would see an established
1392 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1393
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001394 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1395 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1396 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1397 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1398 in a frontend.
1399
1400 Example :
1401 listen http_proxy
1402 bind :80,:443
1403 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
1404
1405 See also : "source".
1406
1407
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001408bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1409 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1411 yes | yes | yes | yes
1412 Arguments :
1413 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1414 may be used to override a default value.
1415
1416 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1417 option may be combined with other numbers.
1418
1419 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1420 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1421 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1422 missing from all processes.
1423
1424 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1425 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1426 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1427 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1428
1429 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1430 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1431 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1432 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1433 and 'even' instances.
1434
1435 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1436 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1437 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1438 32.
1439
1440 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1441 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1442
1443 Example :
1444 listen app_ip1
1445 bind 10.0.0.1:80
1446 bind_process odd
1447
1448 listen app_ip2
1449 bind 10.0.0.2:80
1450 bind_process even
1451
1452 listen management
1453 bind 10.0.0.3:80
1454 bind_process 1 2 3 4
1455
1456 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1457
1458
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001459block { if | unless } <condition>
1460 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1462 no | yes | yes | yes
1463
1464 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1465 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001466 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001467 typically used to deny access to certain sensible resources if some
1468 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1469 "block" statements per instance.
1470
1471 Example:
1472 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1473 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1474 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1475 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1476
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001477 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001478
1479
1480capture cookie <name> len <length>
1481 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1483 no | yes | yes | no
1484 Arguments :
1485 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1486 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1487 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1488 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1489 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1490
1491 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1492 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1493 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1494 right if it exceeds <length>.
1495
1496 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1497 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1498 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1499 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1500
1501 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1502 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1503 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1504
1505 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1506 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1507 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1508 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001509 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001510 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1511
1512 Example:
1513 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1514
1515 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001516 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001517
1518
1519capture request header <name> len <length>
1520 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1522 no | yes | yes | no
1523 Arguments :
1524 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001525 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001526 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1527 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1528 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1529
1530 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1531 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1532 it exceeds <length>.
1533
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001534 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001535 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1536 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001537 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1538 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1539 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1540 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001541 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001542 environments to find where the request came from.
1543
1544 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1545 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1546 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1547 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001548
1549 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1550 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1551 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1552 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1553
1554 Example:
1555 capture request header Host len 15
1556 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1557 capture request header Referrer len 15
1558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001559 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001560 about logging.
1561
1562
1563capture response header <name> len <length>
1564 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1566 no | yes | yes | no
1567 Arguments :
1568 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001569 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001570 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1571 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1572 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1573
1574 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1575 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1576 it exceeds <length>.
1577
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001578 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001579 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1580 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1581 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001582 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1583 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1584 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1585 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001586
1587 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1588 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1589 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1590 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1591
1592 Example:
1593 capture response header Content-length len 9
1594 capture response header Location len 15
1595
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001596 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001597 about logging.
1598
1599
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001600clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001601 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1603 yes | yes | yes | no
1604 Arguments :
1605 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1606 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1607 as explained at the top of this document.
1608
1609 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1610 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1611 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1612 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1613 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1614 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1615 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1616 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001617 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001618 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1619 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1620
1621 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1622 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1623 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1624 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1625 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1626 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1627
1628 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1629 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1630
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001631 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1632 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001633
1634
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001635contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001636 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1638 yes | no | yes | yes
1639 Arguments :
1640 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1641 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1642 as explained at the top of this document.
1643
1644 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001645 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001646 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001647 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1648 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1649 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1650 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1651
1652 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1653 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1654 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1655 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1656 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1657 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1658
1659 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1660 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1661 instead.
1662
1663 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1664 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1665
1666
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001667cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001668 [ postonly ] [ domain <domain> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001669 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1671 yes | no | yes | yes
1672 Arguments :
1673 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1674 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1675 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1676 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1677 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1678 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1679 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1680 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1681 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1682
1683 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1684 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1685 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1686 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1687 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1688 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1689 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1690 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1691 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1692 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1693 "insert" and "prefix".
1694
1695 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001696 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
1697 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
1698 server. If the server emits a cookie with the same name, it will
1699 be remove before processing. For this reason, this mode can be
1700 used to upgrade existing configurations running in the "rewrite"
1701 mode. The cookie will only be a session cookie and will not be
1702 stored on the client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect"
1703 option is added, the server will see the cookies emitted by the
1704 client. Due to caching effects, it is generally wise to add the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001705 "nocache" or "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert"
1706 keyword is not compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
1707
1708 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1709 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1710 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1711 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1712 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1713 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1714 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1715 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1716 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1717 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
1718 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert".
1719
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001720 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1721 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1722 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
1723 it will be removed. In "insert" mode, this will additionally
1724 remove cookies from requests transmitted to the server, making
1725 the persistence mechanism totally transparent from an application
1726 point of view.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001727
1728 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1729 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1730 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1731 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1732 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1733 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1734 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1735 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1736 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1737
1738 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1739 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1740 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1741 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1742 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1743 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1744 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1745 persistence cookie in the cache.
1746 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1747
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001748 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001749 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001750 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1751 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1752 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1753 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1754 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1755 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001756
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001757 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
1758 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
1759 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
1760 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001761
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001762 Examples :
1763 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
1764 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
1765 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
1766
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001767 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001768 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001769
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001770
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001771default-server [param*]
1772 Change default options for a server in a backend
1773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1774 yes | no | yes | yes
1775 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001776 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1777 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1778 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1779 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001780
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001781 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001782 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
1783
1784 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001785
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001786
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001787default_backend <backend>
1788 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
1789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1790 yes | yes | yes | no
1791 Arguments :
1792 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
1793
1794 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
1795 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
1796 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
1797 will catch all undetermined requests.
1798
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001799 Example :
1800
1801 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
1802 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
1803 default_backend dynamic
1804
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001805 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
1806
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001807
1808disabled
1809 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
1810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1811 yes | yes | yes | yes
1812 Arguments : none
1813
1814 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
1815 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
1816 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
1817 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
1818 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
1819 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
1820 keyword in a "defaults" section.
1821
1822 See also : "enabled"
1823
1824
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02001825dispatch <address>:<port>
1826 Set a default server address
1827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1828 no | no | yes | yes
1829 Arguments : none
1830
1831 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
1832 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
1833 during start-up.
1834
1835 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
1836 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
1837 possible with normal servers.
1838
1839 The "disabled" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
1840 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
1841 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
1842 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
1843 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
1844
1845 See also : "server"
1846
1847
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001848enabled
1849 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
1850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1851 yes | yes | yes | yes
1852 Arguments : none
1853
1854 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
1855 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
1856
1857 See also : "disabled"
1858
1859
1860errorfile <code> <file>
1861 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
1862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1863 yes | yes | yes | yes
1864 Arguments :
1865 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
1866 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
1867
1868 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001869 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001870 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01001871 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
1872 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001873
1874 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
1875 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
1876 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
1877
1878 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
1879 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
1880 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
1881 files returning the same contents as default errors.
1882
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01001883 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
1884 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
1885 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
1886 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
1887 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
1888 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
1889
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001890 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
1891 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
1892 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01001893 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001894 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
1895
1896 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
1897
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01001898 Example :
1899 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
1900 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
1901 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
1902
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001903
1904errorloc <code> <url>
1905errorloc302 <code> <url>
1906 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
1907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1908 yes | yes | yes | yes
1909 Arguments :
1910 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
1911 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
1912
1913 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
1914 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
1915 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
1916 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
1917 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
1918
1919 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
1920 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
1921 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
1922
1923 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
1924 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
1925 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
1926 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
1927 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
1928 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
1929 request.
1930
1931 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
1932
1933
1934errorloc303 <code> <url>
1935 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
1936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1937 yes | yes | yes | yes
1938 Arguments :
1939 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
1940 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
1941
1942 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
1943 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
1944 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
1945 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
1946 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
1947
1948 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
1949 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
1950 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
1951
1952 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
1953 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
1954 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
1955 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001956 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001957
1958 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
1959
1960
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01001961force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
1962 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
1963 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1964 no | yes | yes | yes
1965
1966 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
1967 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
1968 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
1969 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
1970 marked down for maintenance operations.
1971
1972 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
1973 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
1974 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
1975 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
1976 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
1977 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
1978 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
1979 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
1980 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
1981
1982 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
1983 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
1984 is used.
1985
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001986 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001987 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01001988
1989
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001990fullconn <conns>
1991 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
1992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1993 yes | no | yes | yes
1994 Arguments :
1995 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
1996 servers use the maximal number of connections.
1997
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01001998 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001999 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002000 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002001 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2002 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2003 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2004 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2005 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002006 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002007
2008 Example :
2009 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2010 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2011 # connections.
2012 backend dynamic
2013 fullconn 10000
2014 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2015 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2016
2017 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2018
2019
2020grace <time>
2021 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002023 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002024 Arguments :
2025 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2026 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2027 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2028
2029 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2030 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002031 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002032 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2033
2034 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2035 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2036 simplify it.
2037
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002038
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002039hash-type <method>
2040 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2042 yes | no | yes | yes
2043 Arguments :
2044 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2045 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2046 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2047 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2048 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2049 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2050 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2051 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2052 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2053
2054 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2055 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2056 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2057 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2058 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2059 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2060 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2061 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2062 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2063 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2064 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2065 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2066 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2067
2068 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2069
2070 See also : "balance", "server"
2071
2072
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002073http-check disable-on-404
2074 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002076 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002077 Arguments : none
2078
2079 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2080 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2081 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2082 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2083 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2084 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2085 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2086 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002087 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2088 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2089 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2090
2091 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2092
2093
2094http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2095 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2097 no | no | yes | yes
2098 Arguments :
2099 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2100 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
2101 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
2102 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2103 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2104 details on the supported keywords.
2105
2106 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2107 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2108 with the usual backslash ('\').
2109
2110 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2111 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2112 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2113 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2114 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2115
2116 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2117 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2118 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2119 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2120 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2121
2122 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2123 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2124 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2125 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2126 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2127 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2128
2129 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2130 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2131 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2132 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2133 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2134 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2135 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2136 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2137 trace).
2138
2139 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2140 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2141 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2142 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2143 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2144 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2145 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2146 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2147
2148 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2149 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2150 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2151 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2152 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2153 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2154 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2155 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2156
2157 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2158 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2159
2160 Examples :
2161 # only accept status 200 as valid
2162 http-request expect status 200
2163
2164 # consider SQL errors as errors
2165 http-request expect ! string SQL\ Error
2166
2167 # consider status 5xx only as errors
2168 http-request expect ! rstatus ^5
2169
2170 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
2171 http-request expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002172
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002173 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002174
2175
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002176http-check send-state
2177 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2179 yes | no | yes | yes
2180 Arguments : none
2181
2182 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2183 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2184 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2185 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2186 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2187
2188 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2189 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2190 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2191 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2192 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2193 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2194 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2195 checked in multiple backends.
2196
2197 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2198 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2199
2200 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2201 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2202 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2203 one fails.
2204
2205 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2206 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2207 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2208
2209 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2210 server's queue.
2211
2212 Example of a header received by the application server :
2213 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2214 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2215
2216 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2217
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002218http-request { allow | deny | http-auth [realm <realm>] }
2219 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002220 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2221
2222 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2223 no | yes | yes | yes
2224
2225 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2226 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2227 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
2228 For "block" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2229 performed, for "http-auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
2230 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2231
2232 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2233 instance.
2234
2235 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002236 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2237 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2238 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002239
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002240 http-request allow if nagios
2241 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2242 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2243 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002244
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002245 Example:
2246 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002247
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002248 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002249
2250 See section 3.4 about userlists and 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002251
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002252id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002253 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2255 no | yes | yes | yes
2256 Arguments : none
2257
2258 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2259 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2260 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002261
2262
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002263ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2264 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2265 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2266 no | yes | yes | yes
2267
2268 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2269 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2270 and running).
2271
2272 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2273 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2274 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2275 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2276 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2277
2278 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2279 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2280
2281 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2282 "unless" condition is met.
2283
2284 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2285
2286
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002287log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002288log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002289 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2291 yes | yes | yes | yes
2292 Arguments :
2293 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2294 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2295 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2296 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2297 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2298 parameter.
2299
2300 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2301 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2302
2303 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2304 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2305 standard syslog port).
2306
2307 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2308 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2309 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2310 appropriately writeable).
2311
2312 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2313
2314 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2315 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2316 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2317
2318 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2319 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2320 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002321 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2322 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2323 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2324 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2325 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002326
2327 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2328
2329 Note that up to two "log" entries may be specified per instance. However, if
2330 "log global" is used and if the "global" section already contains 2 log
2331 entries, then additional log entries will be ignored.
2332
2333 Also, it is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002334 what to log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log
2335 entries from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level
2336 "info".
2337
2338 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2339 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2340 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2341 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2342
2343 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2344 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002345
2346 Example :
2347 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002348 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2349 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002350
2351
2352maxconn <conns>
2353 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2355 yes | yes | yes | no
2356 Arguments :
2357 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2358 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2359 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2360 closes.
2361
2362 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2363 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2364 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2365 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2366 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2367 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2368 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2369 properly tuned.
2370
2371 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2372 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2373 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2374
2375 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2376
2377
2378mode { tcp|http|health }
2379 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2381 yes | yes | yes | yes
2382 Arguments :
2383 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2384 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2385 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2386 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2387
2388 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2389 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2390 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2391 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2392 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2393
2394 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2395 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2396 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2397 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2398 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2399 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2400
2401 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2402 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2403 will be refused.
2404
2405 Example :
2406 defaults http_instances
2407 mode http
2408
2409 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
2410
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002411
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002412monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002413 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2415 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002416 Arguments :
2417 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2418 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002419 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002420 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2421 backend and its backup.
2422
2423 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2424 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2425 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2426 servers in a list of backends.
2427
2428 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2429 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2430 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2431 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2432 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2433 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2434 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002435 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002436
2437 Example:
2438 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002439 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002440 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2441 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2442 monitor-uri /site_alive
2443 monitor fail if site_dead
2444
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002445 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri"
2446
2447
2448monitor-net <source>
2449 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2451 yes | yes | yes | no
2452 Arguments :
2453 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2454 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2455 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2456 followed by a mask.
2457
2458 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2459 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002460 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002461 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2462
2463 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2464 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2465 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2466 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2467 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2468
2469 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2470 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2471 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2472 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2473 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2474
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002475 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2476 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
2477
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002478 Example :
2479 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2480 frontend www
2481 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2482
2483 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2484
2485
2486monitor-uri <uri>
2487 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2489 yes | yes | yes | no
2490 Arguments :
2491 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2492 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2493
2494 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2495 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2496 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2497 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2498 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2499 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2500 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2501 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2502
2503 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2504 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2505 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2506 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2507 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2508 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2509
2510 Example :
2511 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2512 frontend www
2513 mode http
2514 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2515
2516 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2517
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002518
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002519option abortonclose
2520no option abortonclose
2521 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2523 yes | no | yes | yes
2524 Arguments : none
2525
2526 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2527 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2528 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2529 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002530 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002531 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2532 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2533 encountered while delivering the response.
2534
2535 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2536 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2537 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2538 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2539 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2540 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002541 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002542 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002543 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002544 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2545 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2546 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2547
2548 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2549 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2550 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2551 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2552 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2553 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2554 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2555 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002556 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002557
2558 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2559 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2560
2561 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2562
2563
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002564option accept-invalid-http-request
2565no option accept-invalid-http-request
2566 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2568 yes | yes | yes | no
2569 Arguments : none
2570
2571 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2572 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2573 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2574 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2575 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2576 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2577 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2578 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2579 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2580
2581 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2582 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2583 been confirmed.
2584
2585 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2586 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
2587 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Doing this
2588 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2589
2590 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2591 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2592
2593 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2594 stats socket.
2595
2596
2597option accept-invalid-http-response
2598no option accept-invalid-http-response
2599 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2601 yes | no | yes | yes
2602 Arguments : none
2603
2604 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2605 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2606 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2607 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2608 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2609 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2610 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2611 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2612 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2613
2614 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2615 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2616 been confirmed.
2617
2618 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2619 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2620 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2621 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2622
2623 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2624 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2625
2626 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2627 stats socket.
2628
2629
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002630option allbackups
2631no option allbackups
2632 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2634 yes | no | yes | yes
2635 Arguments : none
2636
2637 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2638 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2639 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2640 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2641 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2642 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2643 order between the backup servers anymore.
2644
2645 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2646 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2647
2648 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2649 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2650
2651
2652option checkcache
2653no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002654 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2656 yes | no | yes | yes
2657 Arguments : none
2658
2659 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2660 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002661 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002662 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2663 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
2664 some sensible session information go in the wild.
2665
2666 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002667 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002668 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002669 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2670 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002671 to the client are :
2672 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002673 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002674 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002675 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2676 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2677 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2678 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2679 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2680 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2681 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2682 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2683 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2684 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2685 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2686
2687 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002688 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002689 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002690 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002691 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
2692
2693 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
2694 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002695 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002696 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
2697
2698 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2699 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2700
2701
2702option clitcpka
2703no option clitcpka
2704 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
2705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2706 yes | yes | yes | no
2707 Arguments : none
2708
2709 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
2710 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
2711 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
2712 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
2713
2714 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
2715 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
2716 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
2717 operating system and its tuning parameters.
2718
2719 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
2720 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
2721 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
2722 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
2723 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
2724
2725 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
2726
2727 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
2728 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
2729 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
2730
2731 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2732 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2733
2734 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
2735
2736
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002737option contstats
2738 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
2739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2740 yes | yes | yes | no
2741 Arguments : none
2742
2743 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
2744 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
2745 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
2746 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
2747 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
2748 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
2749 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
2750
2751
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002752option dontlog-normal
2753no option dontlog-normal
2754 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
2755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2756 yes | yes | yes | no
2757 Arguments : none
2758
2759 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
2760 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
2761 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
2762 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
2763 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
2764 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
2765 logged.
2766
2767 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
2768 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
2769 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
2770
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002771 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002772 logging.
2773
2774
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002775option dontlognull
2776no option dontlognull
2777 Enable or disable logging of null connections
2778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2779 yes | yes | yes | no
2780 Arguments : none
2781
2782 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
2783 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
2784 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
2785 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
2786 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
2787 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
2788 which typically corresponds to those probes.
2789
2790 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
2791 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
2792 would not be logged.
2793
2794 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2795 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002797 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002798
2799
2800option forceclose
2801no option forceclose
2802 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
2803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01002804 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002805 Arguments : none
2806
2807 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
2808 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
2809 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
2810 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
2811 global session times in the logs.
2812
2813 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01002814 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01002815 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
2816 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
2817 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
2818 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002819
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002820 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
2821 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
2822 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
2823
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002824 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2825 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2826
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002827 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002828
2829
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002830option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002831 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
2832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2833 yes | yes | yes | yes
2834 Arguments :
2835 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
2836 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002837 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002838 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002839
2840 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
2841 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
2842 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
2843 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
2844 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
2845 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
2846 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002847 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
2848 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
2849 possible that the client has already brought one.
2850
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002851 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002852 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002853 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
2854 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002855 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
2856 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002857
2858 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
2859 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
2860 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
2861 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
2862 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
2863 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
2864 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
2865
2866 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002867 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
2868 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
2869 both are defined.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002870
2871 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
2872 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
2873 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
2874 when using this option.
2875
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002876 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002877 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
2878 frontend www
2879 mode http
2880 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
2881
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002882 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
2883 backend www
2884 mode http
2885 option forwardfor header X-Client
2886
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002887 See also : "option httpclose"
2888
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002889
2890option http-pretend-keepalive
2891no option http-pretend-keepalive
2892 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
2893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2894 yes | yes | yes | yes
2895 Arguments : none
2896
2897 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
2898 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
2899 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
2900 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
2901 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
2902 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
2903 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
2904 consider the response complete.
2905
2906 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
2907 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
2908 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
2909 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
2910 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
2911 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
2912
2913 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
2914 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
2915 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
2916 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
2917 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
2918 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
2919 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
2920
2921 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
2922 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02002923 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
2924 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
2925 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002926
2927 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2928 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2929
2930 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
2931
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002932
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01002933option http-server-close
2934no option http-server-close
2935 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
2936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2937 yes | yes | yes | yes
2938 Arguments : none
2939
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02002940 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
2941 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
2942 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
2943 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
2944 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
2945 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
2946 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
2947 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
2948 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
2949 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
2950 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
2951 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01002952
2953 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
2954 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
2955 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
2956 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01002957 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
2958 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01002959
2960 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
2961 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01002962 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
2963 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
2964 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01002965
2966 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2967 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2968
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02002969 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
2970 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01002971
2972
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01002973option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002974no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01002975 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
2976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2977 yes | yes | yes | no
2978 Arguments : none
2979
2980 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
2981 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
2982 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
2983 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
2984 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
2985 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
2986 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
2987
2988 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
2989 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
2990 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
2991 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
2992 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
2993 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
2994 request along its whole life.
2995
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01002996 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
2997 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
2998 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
2999 front of an existing proxy.
3000
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003001 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3002
3003 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3004 http-server-close".
3005
3006
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003007option httpchk
3008option httpchk <uri>
3009option httpchk <method> <uri>
3010option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3011 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3013 yes | no | yes | yes
3014 Arguments :
3015 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3016 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3017 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3018 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3019 ones.
3020
3021 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3022 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3023 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3024
3025 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3026 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3027 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3028 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3029 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3030
3031 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3032 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3033 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3034 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3035 the lack of any response.
3036
3037 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3038
3039 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3040 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3041 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3042
3043 Examples :
3044 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3045 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3046 backend https_relay
3047 mode tcp
3048 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3049 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3050
3051 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
3052 "http-check" and the "check", "port" and "inter" server options.
3053
3054
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003055option httpclose
3056no option httpclose
3057 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3059 yes | yes | yes | yes
3060 Arguments : none
3061
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003062 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3063 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3064 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3065 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3066 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3067 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3068 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003069
3070 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003071 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3072 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3073 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3074 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3075 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3076 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003077
3078 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3079 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3080 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003081 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3082 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003083
3084 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3085 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3086
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003087 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3088 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003089
3090
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003091option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003092 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3094 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003095 Arguments :
3096 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3097 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3098 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3099 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3100 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003101
3102 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3103 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3104 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3105 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3106 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3107 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3108 ports.
3109
3110 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3111
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003112 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3113 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3114 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3115 by default.
3116
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003117 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003118
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003119
3120option http_proxy
3121no option http_proxy
3122 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3124 yes | yes | yes | yes
3125 Arguments : none
3126
3127 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3128 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3129 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3130 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3131 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3132
3133 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3134 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3135 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3136 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
3137 needed to add "option http_close" to ensure that all requests will correctly
3138 be analyzed.
3139
3140 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3141 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3142
3143 Example :
3144 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3145 backend direct_forward
3146 option httpclose
3147 option http_proxy
3148
3149 See also : "option httpclose"
3150
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003151
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003152option ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3153 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3154 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3155 no | yes | yes | yes
3156
3157 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3158 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3159 and running).
3160
3161 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3162 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3163 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
3164 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
3165 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3166
3167 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3168 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3169
3170 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3171 "unless" condition is met.
3172
3173 See also : "option force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3174
3175
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003176option independant-streams
3177no option independant-streams
3178 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3180 yes | yes | yes | yes
3181 Arguments : none
3182
3183 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3184 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3185 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3186 receive data or not.
3187
3188 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3189 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3190 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3191 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3192 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3193 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3194 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3195 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3196 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3197 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3198 socket buffers.
3199
3200 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3201 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3202 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3203 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3204 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3205
3206 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout server"
3207
3208
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003209option ldap-check
3210 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3212 yes | no | yes | yes
3213 Arguments : none
3214
3215 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3216 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3217 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3218 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3219
3220 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3221 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3222
3223 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3224 configure it.
3225
3226 Example :
3227 option ldap-check
3228
3229 See also : "option httpchk"
3230
3231
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003232option log-health-checks
3233no option log-health-checks
3234 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3236 yes | no | yes | yes
3237 Arguments : none
3238
3239 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3240 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3241 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3242 of additional information is limited.
3243
3244 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3245 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3246
3247 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3248
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003249
3250option log-separate-errors
3251no option log-separate-errors
3252 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3254 yes | yes | yes | no
3255 Arguments : none
3256
3257 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3258 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3259 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3260 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3261 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3262 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3263 provides very important information.
3264
3265 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3266 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3267 error logs.
3268
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003269 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003270 logging.
3271
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003272
3273option logasap
3274no option logasap
3275 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3277 yes | yes | yes | no
3278 Arguments : none
3279
3280 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3281 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3282 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3283 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3284 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3285 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3286 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003287 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003288 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3289 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3290
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003291 Examples :
3292 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3293 mode http
3294 option httplog
3295 option logasap
3296 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3297
3298 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3299 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3300 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3301 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003303 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003304 logging.
3305
3306
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003307option mysql-check
3308 Use Mysql health checks for server testing
3309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3310 yes | no | yes | yes
3311 Arguments : none
3312
3313 The check consists in parsing Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or Error
3314 packet, which is sent by MySQL server on connect. It is a basic but useful
3315 test which does not produce any logging on the server. However, it does not
3316 check database presence nor database consistency, nor user permission to
3317 access. To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
3318
3319 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3320 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3321 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3322 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3323 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3324 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3325
3326 See also: "option httpchk"
3327
3328
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003329option nolinger
3330no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003331 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003332 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3333 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003334 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003335
3336 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3337 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3338 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3339 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3340 connections.
3341
3342 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3343 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3344 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3345 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3346 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3347 this too.
3348
3349 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3350 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3351 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3352
3353 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3354 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3355 for servers.
3356
3357 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3358 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3359
3360
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003361option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3362 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3364 yes | yes | yes | yes
3365 Arguments :
3366 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3367 matching <network>
3368 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3369 header name.
3370
3371 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3372 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3373 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3374 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3375 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3376 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3377 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3378 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3379 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3380 possible that the client has already brought one.
3381
3382 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3383 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3384 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3385 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3386 header and requires different one.
3387
3388 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3389 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3390 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3391 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3392 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3393 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3394 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3395
3396 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3397 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3398 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3399 both are defined.
3400
3401 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3402 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3403 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3404 when using this option.
3405
3406 Examples :
3407 # Original Destination address
3408 frontend www
3409 mode http
3410 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3411
3412 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3413 backend www
3414 mode http
3415 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3416
3417 See also : "option httpclose"
3418
3419
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003420option persist
3421no option persist
3422 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3423 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3424 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003425 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003426
3427 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3428 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3429 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3430 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3431 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3432 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3433 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3434 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3435 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3436 redirected to another valid server.
3437
3438 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3439 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3440
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003441 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003442
3443
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003444option redispatch
3445no option redispatch
3446 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3447 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3448 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003449 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003450
3451 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3452 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3453 be able to access the service anymore.
3454
3455 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3456 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3457
3458 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3459 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3460 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003461
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003462 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3463 "redisp" keywords.
3464
3465 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3466 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3467
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003468 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003469
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003470
3471option smtpchk
3472option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3473 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3475 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003476 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003477 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3478 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3479 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3480
3481 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3482 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3483 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3484
3485 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3486 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3487 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3488 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3489 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3490 dead server.
3491
3492 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3493 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3494 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3495 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3496
3497 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3498 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3499 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3500 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3501 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3502
3503 Example :
3504 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3505
3506 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3507
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003508
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003509option socket-stats
3510no option socket-stats
3511
3512 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3514 yes | yes | yes | no
3515
3516 Arguments : none
3517
3518
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003519option splice-auto
3520no option splice-auto
3521 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3523 yes | yes | yes | yes
3524 Arguments : none
3525
3526 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3527 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3528 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3529 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003530 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003531 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3532 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3533 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3534 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3535
3536 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3537 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3538 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3539 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3540 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3541 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3542 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3543 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3544 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3545 keyword.
3546
3547 Example :
3548 option splice-auto
3549
3550 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3551 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3552
3553 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3554 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3555
3556
3557option splice-request
3558no option splice-request
3559 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3561 yes | yes | yes | yes
3562 Arguments : none
3563
3564 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3565 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3566 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3567 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3568 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3569 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3570
3571 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3572
3573 Example :
3574 option splice-request
3575
3576 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3577 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3578
3579 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3580 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3581
3582
3583option splice-response
3584no option splice-response
3585 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3587 yes | yes | yes | yes
3588 Arguments : none
3589
3590 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3591 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3592 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3593 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3594 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3595 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3596
3597 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3598
3599 Example :
3600 option splice-response
3601
3602 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3603 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3604
3605 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3606 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3607
3608
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003609option srvtcpka
3610no option srvtcpka
3611 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
3612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3613 yes | no | yes | yes
3614 Arguments : none
3615
3616 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3617 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3618 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3619 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3620
3621 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3622 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3623 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3624 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3625
3626 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3627 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3628 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3629 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3630 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3631
3632 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3633
3634 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3635 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3636 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
3637
3638 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3639 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3640
3641 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
3642
3643
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003644option ssl-hello-chk
3645 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
3646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3647 yes | no | yes | yes
3648 Arguments : none
3649
3650 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
3651 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
3652 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
3653 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
3654 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
3655 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
3656 hello message.
3657
3658 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
3659 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
3660 messages, which is appreciable.
3661
3662 See also: "option httpchk"
3663
3664
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003665option tcp-smart-accept
3666no option tcp-smart-accept
3667 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
3668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3669 yes | yes | yes | no
3670 Arguments : none
3671
3672 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
3673 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
3674 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
3675 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
3676 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
3677 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
3678
3679 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
3680 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
3681 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
3682 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
3683
3684 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
3685 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
3686 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
3687 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
3688
3689 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
3690 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
3691 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
3692
3693 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
3694 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
3695 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
3696
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02003697 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
3698
3699
3700option tcp-smart-connect
3701no option tcp-smart-connect
3702 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
3703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3704 yes | no | yes | yes
3705 Arguments : none
3706
3707 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
3708 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
3709 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
3710 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
3711 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
3712
3713 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
3714 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
3715 complex.
3716
3717 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
3718 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
3719 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
3720
3721 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3722 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3723
3724 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
3725
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003726
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003727option tcpka
3728 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
3729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3730 yes | yes | yes | yes
3731 Arguments : none
3732
3733 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3734 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3735 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3736 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3737
3738 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3739 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3740 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3741 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3742
3743 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3744 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3745 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3746 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3747 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3748
3749 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3750
3751 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
3752 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
3753 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
3754 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
3755 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
3756 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
3757 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
3758 backends.
3759
3760 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
3761
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003762
3763option tcplog
3764 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
3765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3766 yes | yes | yes | yes
3767 Arguments : none
3768
3769 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3770 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3771 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
3772 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
3773 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
3774 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
3775 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
3776 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
3777
3778 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003780 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003781
3782
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003783option transparent
3784no option transparent
3785 Enable client-side transparent proxying
3786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01003787 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003788 Arguments : none
3789
3790 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
3791 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
3792 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
3793 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
3794 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
3795 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
3796 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
3797 appropriate server.
3798
3799 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
3800 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
3801
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003802 See also: the "usersrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
3803 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003804
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003805
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02003806persist rdp-cookie
3807persist rdp-cookie(name)
3808 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
3809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3810 yes | no | yes | yes
3811 Arguments :
3812 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02003813 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
3814 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02003815
3816 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
3817 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
3818 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
3819 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
3820 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
3821 forwarded to this server.
3822
3823 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
3824 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
3825 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003826 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02003827 a single "listen" section.
3828
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02003829 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
3830 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
3831 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
3832
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02003833 Example :
3834 listen tse-farm
3835 bind :3389
3836 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
3837 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
3838 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
3839 # apply RDP cookie persistence
3840 persist rdp-cookie
3841 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
3842 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
3843 balance rdp-cookie
3844 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
3845 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
3846
3847 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
3848
3849
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01003850rate-limit sessions <rate>
3851 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
3852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3853 yes | yes | yes | no
3854 Arguments :
3855 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
3856 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
3857
3858 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
3859 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
3860 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
3861 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
3862 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
3863 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
3864
3865 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
3866 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
3867 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
3868 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
3869
3870 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
3871 listen smtp
3872 mode tcp
3873 bind :25
3874 rate-limit sessions 10
3875 server 127.0.0.1:1025
3876
3877 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status appears as
3878 "FULL" in the statistics, exactly as when it is saturated.
3879
3880 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
3881
3882
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01003883redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
3884redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02003885 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
3886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3887 no | yes | yes | yes
3888
3889 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01003890 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02003891
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01003892 Arguments :
3893 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
3894 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
3895 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
3896 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01003897 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
3898 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
3899 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
3900 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01003901
3902 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
3903 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
3904 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
3905 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
3906 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
3907 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
3908 location with a GET method.
3909
3910 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
3911 expected behaviour of a redirection :
3912
3913 - "drop-query"
3914 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
3915 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
3916 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
3917 with a location-type redirect.
3918
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01003919 - "append-slash"
3920 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
3921 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
3922 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
3923 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
3924
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01003925 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
3926 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
3927 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
3928 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
3929 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
3930 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
3931 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
3932
3933 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
3934 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
3935 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
3936 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
3937 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
3938 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
3939 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02003940
3941 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
3942 acl clear dst_port 80
3943 acl secure dst_port 8080
3944 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01003945 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01003946 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01003947 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
3948
3949 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01003950 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
3951 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
3952 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01003953 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02003954
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01003955 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
3956 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
3957 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
3958
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003959 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02003960
3961
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003962redisp (deprecated)
3963redispatch (deprecated)
3964 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3965 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3966 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003967 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003968
3969 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3970 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3971 be able to access the service anymore.
3972
3973 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
3974 redistribute them to a working server.
3975
3976 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3977 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3978 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003979
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003980 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
3981 "option redispatch" instead.
3982
3983 See also : "option redispatch"
3984
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003985
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01003986reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01003987 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
3988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3989 no | yes | yes | yes
3990 Arguments :
3991 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
3992 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003993 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01003994
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01003995 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
3996 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
3997
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01003998 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
3999 the last header of an HTTP request.
4000
4001 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4002 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4003 responses.
4004
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004005 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4006 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4007 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4008
4009 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4010 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004011
4012
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004013reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4014reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004015 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4017 no | yes | yes | yes
4018 Arguments :
4019 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4020 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4021 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4022 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4023 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4024 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4025 ignores case.
4026
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004027 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4028 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4029
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004030 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4031 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4032 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4033 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004034 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004035
4036 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4037 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4038
4039 Example :
4040 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4041 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4042 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4043
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004044 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4045 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004046
4047
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004048reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4049reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004050 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4052 no | yes | yes | yes
4053 Arguments :
4054 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4055 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4056 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4057 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4058 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4059 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4060
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004061 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4062 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4063
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004064 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4065 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4066 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4067 next servers.
4068
4069 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4070 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4071 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4072
4073 Example :
4074 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4075 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4076 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4077
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004078 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4079 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004080
4081
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004082reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4083reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004084 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4086 no | yes | yes | yes
4087 Arguments :
4088 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4089 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4090 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4091 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4092 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4093 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4094 case.
4095
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004096 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4097 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4098
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004099 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4100 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4101 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4102 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004103 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004104
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004105 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004106 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004107 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004108
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004109 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4110 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4111
4112 Example :
4113 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4114 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4115 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4116
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004117 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4118 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004119
4120
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004121reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4122reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004123 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4125 no | yes | yes | yes
4126 Arguments :
4127 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4128 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4129 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4130 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4131 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4132 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4133 case.
4134
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004135 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4136 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4137
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004138 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4139 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4140 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4141 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4142
4143 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4144 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4145
4146 Example :
4147 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4148 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4149 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4150 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4151
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004152 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4153 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004154
4155
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004156reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4157reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004158 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4160 no | yes | yes | yes
4161 Arguments :
4162 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4163 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4164 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4165 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4166 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4167 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4168
4169 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4170 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4171 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4172 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004173 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004174
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004175 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4176 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4177
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004178 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4179 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4180 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4181
4182 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4183 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4184 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4185 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4186 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4187
4188 Example :
4189 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
4190 reqrep ^([^\ ]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
4191 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4192 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4193
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004194 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4195 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004196
4197
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004198reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4199reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004200 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4202 no | yes | yes | yes
4203 Arguments :
4204 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4205 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4206 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4207 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4208 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4209 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4210 ignores case.
4211
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004212 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4213 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4214
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004215 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4216 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004217 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4218 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4219 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004220 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4221 not set.
4222
4223 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4224 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4225 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4226 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4227 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4228
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004229 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004230 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4231 # block all others.
4232 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4233 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4234
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004235 # block bad guys
4236 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4237 reqitarpit . if badguys
4238
4239 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4240 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004241
4242
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004243retries <value>
4244 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4245 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4246 yes | no | yes | yes
4247 Arguments :
4248 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4249 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4250 default value is 3.
4251
4252 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4253 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4254 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4255
4256 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4257 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4258
4259 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4260 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4261
4262 See also : "option redispatch"
4263
4264
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004265rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004266 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4268 no | yes | yes | yes
4269 Arguments :
4270 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4271 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004272 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004273
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004274 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4275 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4276
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004277 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4278 the last header of an HTTP response.
4279
4280 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4281 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4282 responses.
4283
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004284 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4285 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004286
4287
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004288rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4289rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004290 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4292 no | yes | yes | yes
4293 Arguments :
4294 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4295 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4296 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4297 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4298 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4299 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4300 ignores case.
4301
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004302 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4303 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4304
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004305 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4306 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4307 and/or sensible headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
4308 client.
4309
4310 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4311 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4312 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4313
4314 Example :
4315 # remove the Server header from responses
4316 reqidel ^Server:.*
4317
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004318 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4319 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004320
4321
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004322rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4323rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004324 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4326 no | yes | yes | yes
4327 Arguments :
4328 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4329 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4330 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4331 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4332 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4333 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4334 ignores case.
4335
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004336 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4337 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4338
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004339 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4340 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4341 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4342 case-sensitive.
4343
4344 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004345 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4346 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4347 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004348
4349 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4350 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4351
4352 Example :
4353 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4354 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4355
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004356 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4357 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004358
4359
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004360rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4361rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004362 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4364 no | yes | yes | yes
4365 Arguments :
4366 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4367 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4368 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4369 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4370 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4371 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4372 ignores case.
4373
4374 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4375 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4376 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4377 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004378 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004379
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004380 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4381 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4382
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004383 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4384 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4385 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4386
4387 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4388 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4389 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4390 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4391 are not case-sensitive.
4392
4393 Example :
4394 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4395 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4396
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004397 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4398 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004399
4400
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004401server <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
4402 Declare a server in a backend
4403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4404 no | no | yes | yes
4405 Arguments :
4406 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
4407 appear in logs and alerts.
4408
4409 <address> is the IPv4 address of the server. Alternatively, a resolvable
4410 hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved during
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004411 start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning. It
4412 indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
4413 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4414 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4415 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4416 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4417 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4418 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004419
4420 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4421 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4422 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4423 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4424 adding this value to the client's port.
4425
4426 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4427 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004428 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004429
4430 Examples :
4431 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4432 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4433
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004434 See also: "default-server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004435
4436
4437source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004438source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004439source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004440 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4442 yes | no | yes | yes
4443 Arguments :
4444 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4445 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4446 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4447 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4448
4449 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4450 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004451 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4452 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4453 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004454
4455 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4456 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4457 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4458 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4459 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4460 <addr>.
4461
4462 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4463 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4464 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4465 port.
4466
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004467 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4468 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4469 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4470 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4471 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4472 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4473 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4474 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4475 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4476 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4477 HTTP header.
4478
4479 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4480 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4481 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4482 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4483 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4484 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4485 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4486 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4487 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4488 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4489
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004490 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4491 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4492 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4493 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4494 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4495 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4496
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004497 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4498 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4499 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4500 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4501
4502 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4503 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4504 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4505 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4506 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4507 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4508
4509 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4510 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4511 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4512 there are two methods :
4513
4514 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4515 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4516 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4517 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4518 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4519 of the client ranges may be used.
4520
4521 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4522 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4523 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4524 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4525 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4526 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4527 same session.
4528
4529 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4530 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4531 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4532 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4533 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4534 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4535
4536 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4537 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4538 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004539 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004540
4541 Examples :
4542 backend private
4543 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4544 source 192.168.1.200
4545
4546 backend transparent_ssl1
4547 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4548 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4549
4550 backend transparent_ssl2
4551 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4552 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4553 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4554
4555 backend transparent_ssl3
4556 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4557 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4558 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4559
4560 backend transparent_smtp
4561 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4562 # with Tproxy version 4.
4563 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4564
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004565 backend transparent_http
4566 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4567 # proxy.
4568 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4569
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004570 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004571 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4572
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004573
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004574srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4575 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4577 yes | no | yes | yes
4578 Arguments :
4579 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4580 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4581 as explained at the top of this document.
4582
4583 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4584 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4585 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4586 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4587 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4588 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4589 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4590
4591 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4592 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4593 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4594 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4595 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004596 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004597 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004598 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004599
4600 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4601 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
4602 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
4603 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
4604 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
4605 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
4606
4607 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
4608 Please use "timeout server" instead.
4609
4610 See also : "timeout server", "timeout client" and "clitimeout".
4611
4612
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004613stats auth <user>:<passwd>
4614 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
4615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4616 yes | no | yes | yes
4617 Arguments :
4618 <user> is a user name to grant access to
4619
4620 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
4621
4622 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
4623 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
4624 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
4625 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
4626 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
4627 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
4628
4629 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
4630 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
4631 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
4632 that those ones should not be sensible and not shared with any other account.
4633
4634 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
4635 report using "stats scope".
4636
4637 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4638 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4639 unobvious parameters.
4640
4641 Example :
4642 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4643 backend public_www
4644 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4645 stats enable
4646 stats hide-version
4647 stats scope .
4648 stats uri /admin?stats
4649 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4650 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4651 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4652
4653 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4654 backend private_monitoring
4655 stats enable
4656 stats uri /admin?stats
4657 stats refresh 5s
4658
4659 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
4660
4661
4662stats enable
4663 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
4664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4665 yes | no | yes | yes
4666 Arguments : none
4667
4668 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
4669 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
4670 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
4671 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
4672 - stats auth : no authentication
4673 - stats scope : no restriction
4674
4675 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4676 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4677 unobvious parameters.
4678
4679 Example :
4680 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4681 backend public_www
4682 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4683 stats enable
4684 stats hide-version
4685 stats scope .
4686 stats uri /admin?stats
4687 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4688 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4689 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4690
4691 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4692 backend private_monitoring
4693 stats enable
4694 stats uri /admin?stats
4695 stats refresh 5s
4696
4697 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
4698
4699
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004700stats hide-version
4701 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4703 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004704 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004705
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004706 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
4707 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
4708 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
4709 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
4710 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
4711 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004712
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02004713 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4714 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4715 unobvious parameters.
4716
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004717 Example :
4718 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4719 backend public_www
4720 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02004721 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004722 stats hide-version
4723 stats scope .
4724 stats uri /admin?stats
4725 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4726 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4727 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004728
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004729 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4730 backend private_monitoring
4731 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004732 stats uri /admin?stats
4733 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01004734
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004735 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004736
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004737
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004738stats realm <realm>
4739 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
4740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4741 yes | no | yes | yes
4742 Arguments :
4743 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
4744 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
4745 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
4746
4747 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
4748 using a backslash ('\').
4749
4750 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
4751 only related to authentication.
4752
4753 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4754 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4755 unobvious parameters.
4756
4757 Example :
4758 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4759 backend public_www
4760 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4761 stats enable
4762 stats hide-version
4763 stats scope .
4764 stats uri /admin?stats
4765 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4766 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4767 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4768
4769 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4770 backend private_monitoring
4771 stats enable
4772 stats uri /admin?stats
4773 stats refresh 5s
4774
4775 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
4776
4777
4778stats refresh <delay>
4779 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
4780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4781 yes | no | yes | yes
4782 Arguments :
4783 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
4784 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
4785 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
4786 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
4787 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
4788 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
4789
4790 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
4791 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
4792 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
4793 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
4794
4795 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4796 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4797 unobvious parameters.
4798
4799 Example :
4800 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4801 backend public_www
4802 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4803 stats enable
4804 stats hide-version
4805 stats scope .
4806 stats uri /admin?stats
4807 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4808 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4809 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4810
4811 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4812 backend private_monitoring
4813 stats enable
4814 stats uri /admin?stats
4815 stats refresh 5s
4816
4817 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
4818
4819
4820stats scope { <name> | "." }
4821 Enable statistics and limit access scope
4822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4823 yes | no | yes | yes
4824 Arguments :
4825 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
4826 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
4827 section in which the statement appears.
4828
4829 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
4830 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
4831 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
4832 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
4833 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
4834 exists.
4835
4836 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4837 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4838 unobvious parameters.
4839
4840 Example :
4841 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4842 backend public_www
4843 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4844 stats enable
4845 stats hide-version
4846 stats scope .
4847 stats uri /admin?stats
4848 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4849 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4850 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4851
4852 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4853 backend private_monitoring
4854 stats enable
4855 stats uri /admin?stats
4856 stats refresh 5s
4857
4858 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
4859
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004860
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02004861stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004862 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
4863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4864 yes | no | yes | yes
4865
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02004866 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004867 description from global section is automatically used instead.
4868
4869 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
4870 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
4871
4872 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4873 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4874 unobvious parameters.
4875
4876 Example :
4877 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4878 backend private_monitoring
4879 stats enable
4880 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
4881 stats uri /admin?stats
4882 stats refresh 5s
4883
4884 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
4885 global section.
4886
4887
4888stats show-legends
4889 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
4890 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
4891 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
4892 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
4893 - IP (socket, server)
4894 - cookie (backend, server)
4895
4896 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4897 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4898 unobvious parameters.
4899
4900 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
4901
4902
4903stats show-node [ <name> ]
4904 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
4905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4906 yes | no | yes | yes
4907 Arguments:
4908 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
4909 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
4910
4911 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
4912 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
4913 provided for each customer.
4914
4915 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4916 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4917 unobvious parameters.
4918
4919 Example:
4920 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4921 backend private_monitoring
4922 stats enable
4923 stats show-node Europe-1
4924 stats uri /admin?stats
4925 stats refresh 5s
4926
4927 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
4928 section.
4929
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004930
4931stats uri <prefix>
4932 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
4933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4934 yes | no | yes | yes
4935 Arguments :
4936 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
4937 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
4938 query string.
4939
4940 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
4941 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
4942 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
4943 possible to reach it in the application.
4944
4945 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004946 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004947 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
4948 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
4949 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
4950 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
4951
4952 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
4953 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
4954 an address or a port to statistics only.
4955
4956 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4957 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4958 unobvious parameters.
4959
4960 Example :
4961 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4962 backend public_www
4963 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4964 stats enable
4965 stats hide-version
4966 stats scope .
4967 stats uri /admin?stats
4968 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4969 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4970 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4971
4972 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4973 backend private_monitoring
4974 stats enable
4975 stats uri /admin?stats
4976 stats refresh 5s
4977
4978 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
4979
4980
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004981stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
4982 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004984 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01004985
4986 Arguments :
4987 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
4988 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
4989 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
4990 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
4991
4992 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
4993 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
4994 the "stick-table" statement.
4995
4996 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
4997 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
4998 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
4999 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5000 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5001
5002 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5003 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5004 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5005 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5006 transformation rules.
5007
5008 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5009 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5010 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5011 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5012 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5013 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5014 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5015
5016 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5017 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5018 ACL based conditions.
5019
5020 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5021 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5022 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5023 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5024
5025 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5026 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5027 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5028 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5029
5030 Example :
5031 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5032 # last 30 minutes
5033 backend pop
5034 mode tcp
5035 balance roundrobin
5036 stick store-request src
5037 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5038 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5039 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5040
5041 backend smtp
5042 mode tcp
5043 balance roundrobin
5044 stick match src table pop
5045 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5046 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5047
5048 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5049 extraction.
5050
5051
5052stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5053 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5055 no | no | yes | yes
5056
5057 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5058 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5059 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5060 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5061
5062 Examples :
5063 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005064 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005065
5066 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5067 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5068 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5069
5070
5071 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5072 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5073 backend http
5074 mode http
5075 balance roundrobin
5076 stick on src table https
5077 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5078 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5079 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5080
5081 backend https
5082 mode tcp
5083 balance roundrobin
5084 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5085 stick on src
5086 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5087 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5088
5089 See also : "stick match" and "stick store-request"
5090
5091
5092stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5093 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5095 no | no | yes | yes
5096
5097 Arguments :
5098 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5099 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5100 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5101 server is selected.
5102
5103 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5104 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5105 the "stick-table" statement.
5106
5107 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5108 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5109 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5110 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5111 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5112 address.
5113
5114 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5115 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5116 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5117 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5118 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5119 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5120 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5121 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5122 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5123 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5124
5125 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5126 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5127 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5128 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5129 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5130 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5131 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5132
5133 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5134 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5135 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5136 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5137
5138 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5139 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5140 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5141 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5142 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5143 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5144 another protocol or access method.
5145
5146 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5147 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5148 the request.
5149
5150 Example :
5151 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5152 # last 30 minutes
5153 backend pop
5154 mode tcp
5155 balance roundrobin
5156 stick store-request src
5157 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5158 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5159 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5160
5161 backend smtp
5162 mode tcp
5163 balance roundrobin
5164 stick match src table pop
5165 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5166 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5167
5168 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5169 extraction.
5170
5171
5172stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] } size <size>
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005173 [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005174 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005176 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005177
5178 Arguments :
5179 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5180 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5181 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5182 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5183
5184 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5185 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5186 instance.
5187
5188 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5189 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5190 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5191 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5192 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5193 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
5194 to 31 characters.
5195
5196 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
5197 "string" type table. See type "string" above. Be careful when
5198 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5199 increase.
5200
5201 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005202 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5203 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5204 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005205
5206 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5207 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5208 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5209 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5210 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5211 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5212 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5213 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5214 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5215 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5216 parameter (see below).
5217
5218 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5219 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5220 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5221 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5222 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
5223 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
5224 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5225 if not expiration delay is specified.
5226
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005227 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5228 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5229 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5230 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005231 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5232 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5233 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5234 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5235 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5236 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5237 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5238 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5239 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5240 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5241 types and their arguments.
5242
5243 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5244 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5245 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5246 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5247
5248 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5249 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5250 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5251 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5252
5253 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5254 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5255 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5256 they were received.
5257
5258 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5259 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5260 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5261 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5262 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5263
5264 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5265 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5266 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5267 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5268 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5269
5270 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5271 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5272 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5273
5274 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5275 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5276 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5277 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5278 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5279
5280 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5281 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5282 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5283 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5284 the client side.
5285
5286 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5287 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5288 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5289 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5290 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5291 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5292 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5293
5294 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5295 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5296 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5297 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5298 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5299 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5300 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5301
5302 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5303 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5304 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5305 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5306 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5307 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5308
5309 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5310 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5311 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5312 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5313
5314 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5315 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5316 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5317 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5318 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5319 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5320 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5321 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5322 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5323 recommended for better fairness.
5324
5325 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5326 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5327 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5328 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5329
5330 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5331 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5332 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5333 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5334 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5335 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5336 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5337 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5338 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5339 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005340
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005341 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5342 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005343 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5344 reference it.
5345
5346 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5347 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5348 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5349 as an exclusive stickiness.
5350
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005351 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5352 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5353 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5354 something that can be ignored.
5355
5356 Example:
5357 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5358 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5359 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5360 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5361
5362 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
5363 about time format and section 7 avoud ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005364
5365
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005366tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5367 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5369 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005370 Arguments :
5371 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5372 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5373 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005374
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005375 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005376
5377 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5378 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005379 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5380 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5381 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5382 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5383 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5384 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005385
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005386 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5387 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5388 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5389 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005390
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005391 Three types of actions are supported :
5392 - accept :
5393 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5394 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5395 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005396
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005397 - reject :
5398 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5399 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5400 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5401 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5402 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5403 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5404 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5405 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
5406 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
5407 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
5408 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
5409 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005410
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005411 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
5412 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
5413 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
5414 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
5415 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
5416 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
5417 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
5418 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
5419 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005420
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005421 These actions take one or two arguments :
5422 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
5423 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
5424 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005425
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005426 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
5427 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
5428 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
5429 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005430
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005431 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
5432 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
5433 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
5434 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
5435 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
5436 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
5437 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
5438 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
5439 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
5440 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005441
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005442 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
5443 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5444 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005445
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005446 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
5447 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
5448 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005449
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005450 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005451 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005452 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005453
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005454 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
5455 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
5456 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005457
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005458 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
5459 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5460 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005461
5462 See section 7 about ACL usage.
5463
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005464 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005465
5466
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005467tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5468 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005470 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005471 Arguments :
5472 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5473 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5474 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005475
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005476 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005477
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005478 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
5479 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
5480 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
5481 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
5482 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005483
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005484 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
5485 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
5486 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
5487 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
5488 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
5489 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
5490 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
5491 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
5492 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005493
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005494 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
5495 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
5496 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
5497 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005498
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005499 Three types of actions are supported :
5500 - accept :
5501 - reject :
5502 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005503
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005504 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
5505 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005506
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005507 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
5508 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
5509 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
5510 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
5511 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
5512 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005513
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005514 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005515 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5516 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005517
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005518 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
5519 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full request has been
5520 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
5521 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
5522 period.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005523
5524 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005525 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
5526 # and reject everything else.
5527 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
5528 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5529 tcp-request content accept if HTTP is_host_com
5530 tcp-request content reject
5531
5532 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005533 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
5534 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5535 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005536 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005537
5538 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
5539 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5540 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005541 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005542 tcp-request content reject
5543
5544 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
5545 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
5546
5547 frontend http
5548 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
5549 # protecting all our sites
5550 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
5551 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5552 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
5553 ...
5554 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
5555
5556 backend http_dynamic
5557 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
5558 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
5559 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
5560 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
5561 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
5562 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
5563 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005564
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005565 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005566
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005567 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005568
5569
5570tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
5571 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
5572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005573 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005574 Arguments :
5575 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5576 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5577 as explained at the top of this document.
5578
5579 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
5580 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
5581 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
5582 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
5583 data for at most the specified amount of time.
5584
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005585 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
5586 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
5587 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
5588 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
5589
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005590 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
5591 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005592 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005593 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01005594 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
5595 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
5596 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
5597 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005598
5599 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
5600 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
5601 it pass through unaffected.
5602
5603 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
5604 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
5605 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005606 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005607 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
5608 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02005609 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
5610 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
5611 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005612
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005613 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005614 "timeout client".
5615
5616
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005617timeout check <timeout>
5618 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
5619 established.
5620
5621 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5622 yes | no | yes | yes
5623 Arguments:
5624 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5625 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5626 as explained at the top of this document.
5627
5628 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
5629 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
5630 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
5631 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01005632 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
5633 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
5634 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005635
5636 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
5637 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
5638
5639 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
5640 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01005641 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005642
5643 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5644 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5645 forget about it.
5646
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01005647 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
5648 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005649
5650
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005651timeout client <timeout>
5652timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5653 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
5654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5655 yes | yes | yes | no
5656 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005657 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005658 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5659 as explained at the top of this document.
5660
5661 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
5662 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5663 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
5664 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
5665 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
5666 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
5667 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
5668 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005669 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005670 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
5671 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
5672
5673 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
5674 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5675 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5676 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5677 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5678 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5679
5680 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
5681 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
5682 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
5683
5684 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server".
5685
5686
5687timeout connect <timeout>
5688timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5689 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
5690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5691 yes | no | yes | yes
5692 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005693 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005694 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5695 as explained at the top of this document.
5696
5697 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005698 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005699 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005700 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005701 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
5702 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005703
5704 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5705 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5706 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5707 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5708 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
5709 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5710
5711 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
5712 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
5713 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
5714
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01005715 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
5716 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005717
5718
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005719timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
5720 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
5721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5722 yes | yes | yes | yes
5723 Arguments :
5724 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5725 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5726 as explained at the top of this document.
5727
5728 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
5729 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
5730 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
5731 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
5732 once the request has started to present itself.
5733
5734 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
5735 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
5736 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
5737 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
5738 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
5739
5740 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
5741 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
5742 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
5743 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
5744
5745 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
5746 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
5747 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
5748 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
5749 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02005750 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005751
5752 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
5753 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
5754 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
5755 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
5756
5757 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
5758
5759
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005760timeout http-request <timeout>
5761 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
5762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02005763 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005764 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005765 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005766 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5767 as explained at the top of this document.
5768
5769 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
5770 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
5771 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
5772 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
5773 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
5774 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
5775 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
5776 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
5777
5778 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
5779 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005780 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
5781 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005782
5783 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
5784 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
5785 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
5786 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
5787 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
5788
5789 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02005790 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
5791 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
5792 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005793
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005794 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005795
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005796
5797timeout queue <timeout>
5798 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
5799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5800 yes | no | yes | yes
5801 Arguments :
5802 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5803 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5804 as explained at the top of this document.
5805
5806 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
5807 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
5808 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
5809 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
5810 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
5811
5812 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
5813 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
5814 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
5815 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
5816
5817 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
5818
5819
5820timeout server <timeout>
5821timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5822 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5824 yes | no | yes | yes
5825 Arguments :
5826 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5827 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5828 as explained at the top of this document.
5829
5830 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5831 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5832 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5833 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5834 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5835 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5836 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5837
5838 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5839 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5840 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5841 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5842 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005843 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005844 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005845 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005846
5847 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5848 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5849 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5850 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5851 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5852 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5853
5854 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
5855 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
5856 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
5857
5858 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client".
5859
5860
5861timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005862 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5864 yes | yes | yes | yes
5865 Arguments :
5866 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
5867 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5868 as explained at the top of this document.
5869
5870 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
5871 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
5872 defines how long it will be maintained open.
5873
5874 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5875 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5876 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
5877 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005878 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005879
5880 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
5881
5882
5883transparent (deprecated)
5884 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005886 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005887 Arguments : none
5888
5889 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
5890 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5891 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5892 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5893 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5894 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5895 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5896 appropriate server.
5897
5898 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
5899
5900 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5901 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5902
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005903 See also: "option transparent"
5904
5905
5906use_backend <backend> if <condition>
5907use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02005908 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5910 no | yes | yes | no
5911 Arguments :
5912 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
5913
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005914 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005915
5916 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
5917 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
5918 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02005919 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
5920 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
5921 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
5922 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005923
5924 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
5925 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
5926 assign the backend.
5927
5928 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
5929 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
5930 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
5931 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
5932 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
5933 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
5934
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02005935 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005936 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02005937 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
5938 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
5939 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
5940
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02005941 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005942
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005943
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010059445. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005945------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02005946
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005947The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
5948which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
5949arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
5950settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
5951after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
5952Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
5953address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02005954
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005955 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005956 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02005957
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01005958The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005959
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005960addr <ipv4>
5961 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
5962 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
5963 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
5964 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
5965 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02005966
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01005967 Supported in default-server: No
5968
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005969backup
5970 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
5971 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
5972 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
5973 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
5974 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
5975 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02005976
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01005977 Supported in default-server: No
5978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005979check
5980 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
5981 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server will receive
5982 periodic health checks to ensure that it is really able to serve requests.
5983 The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the server,
5984 and the default source is the same as the one defined in the backend. It is
5985 possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the port using the
5986 "port" parameter, the source address using the "source" address, and the
5987 interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall" parameters. The
5988 request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk", "smtpchk",
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005989 "mysql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please refer to those options and
5990 parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005991
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01005992 Supported in default-server: No
5993
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005994cookie <value>
5995 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
5996 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
5997 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
5998 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
5999 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6000 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6001 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6002
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006003 Supported in default-server: No
6004
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006005disabled
6006 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6007 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6008 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6009 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6010 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6011
6012 Supported in default-server: No
6013
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006014error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006015 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6016 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6017 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006018
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006019 Supported in default-server: Yes
6020
6021 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006022
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006023fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006024 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6025 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6026 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6027
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006028 Supported in default-server: Yes
6029
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006030id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006031 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6032 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6033 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006034
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006035 Supported in default-server: No
6036
6037inter <delay>
6038fastinter <delay>
6039downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006040 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6041 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6042 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6043 between checks depending on the server state :
6044
6045 Server state | Interval used
6046 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6047 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6048 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6049 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6050 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6051 or yet unchecked. |
6052 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6053 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6054 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006056 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6057 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6058 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6059 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6060 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6061 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6062 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6063 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6064 servers.
6065
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006066 Supported in default-server: Yes
6067
6068maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006069 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6070 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6071 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6072 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6073 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6074 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6075 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6076 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6077
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006078 Supported in default-server: Yes
6079
6080maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006081 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6082 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6083 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6084 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6085 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6086 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6087 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6088
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006089 Supported in default-server: Yes
6090
6091minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006092 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6093 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6094 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6095 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6096 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6097 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006098 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006099 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006100
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006101 Supported in default-server: Yes
6102
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006103observe <mode>
6104 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6105 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6106 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6107 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6108 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6109 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
6110 headers, a timeout, etc.
6111
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006112 Supported in default-server: No
6113
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006114 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6115
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006116on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006117 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6118 Currently, four modes are available:
6119 - fastinter: force fastinter
6120 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6121 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6122 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6123 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6124
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006125 Supported in default-server: Yes
6126
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006127 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6128
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006129port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006130 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
6131 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
6132 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
6133 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
6134 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
6135 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
6136
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006137 Supported in default-server: Yes
6138
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006139redir <prefix>
6140 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
6141 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
6142 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
6143 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
6144 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
6145 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
6146 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
6147 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006148 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006149 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
6150 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
6151 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
6152 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
6153 loop between the client and HAProxy!
6154
6155 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
6156
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006157 Supported in default-server: No
6158
6159rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006160 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
6161 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
6162 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
6163
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006164 Supported in default-server: Yes
6165
6166slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006167 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
6168 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
6169 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
6170 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
6171 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
6172 parameters :
6173
6174 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
6175 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
6176
6177 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
6178 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
6179 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
6180 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
6181
6182 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
6183 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
6184 seen as failed.
6185
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006186 Supported in default-server: Yes
6187
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006188source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006189source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006190source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006191 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
6192 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
6193 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
6194 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
6195
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006196 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
6197 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
6198 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
6199 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
6200 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
6201 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
6202 server.
6203
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006204 Supported in default-server: No
6205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006206track [<proxy>/]<server>
6207 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
6208 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
6209 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
6210 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
6211 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
6212
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006213 Supported in default-server: No
6214
6215weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006216 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
6217 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
6218 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02006219 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
6220 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
6221 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
6222 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
6223 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
6224 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006225
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006226 Supported in default-server: Yes
6227
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006228
62296. HTTP header manipulation
6230---------------------------
6231
6232In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
6233response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
6234request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
6235which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
6236against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
6237to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
6238passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
6239headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
6240never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
6241
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006242There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
6243(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
6244rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
6245messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
6246in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006247happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006248add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
6249normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
6250
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006251This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
6252in section 4.2 :
6253
6254 - reqadd <string>
6255 - reqallow <search>
6256 - reqiallow <search>
6257 - reqdel <search>
6258 - reqidel <search>
6259 - reqdeny <search>
6260 - reqideny <search>
6261 - reqpass <search>
6262 - reqipass <search>
6263 - reqrep <search> <replace>
6264 - reqirep <search> <replace>
6265 - reqtarpit <search>
6266 - reqitarpit <search>
6267 - rspadd <string>
6268 - rspdel <search>
6269 - rspidel <search>
6270 - rspdeny <search>
6271 - rspideny <search>
6272 - rsprep <search> <replace>
6273 - rspirep <search> <replace>
6274
6275With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
6276is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
6277parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
6278prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
6279Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
6280
6281 \t for a tab
6282 \r for a carriage return (CR)
6283 \n for a new line (LF)
6284 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
6285 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
6286 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
6287 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
6288 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
6289
6290The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
6291portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
6292above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
6293regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
62949 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
6295is very common to users of the "sed" program.
6296
6297The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
6298after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
6299
6300Notes related to these keywords :
6301---------------------------------
6302 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
6303 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
6304 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
6305
6306 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
6307 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
6308 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
6309
6310 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
6311 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
6312 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
6313 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
6314 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
6315
6316 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
6317 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
6318 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
6319 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
6320 useless headers before adding new ones.
6321
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006322 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006323 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
6324
6325 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
6326 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
6327 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
6328
6329 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
6330 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006331 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006332
6333
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010063347. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
6335------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006336
6337The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
6338content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
6339from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
6340simple :
6341
6342 - define test criteria with sets of values
6343 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
6344
6345The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
6346
6347In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
6348
6349 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
6350
6351This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
6352Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
6353and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
6354an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
6355of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
6356
6357ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
6358'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
6359which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
6360
6361There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
6362performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
6363
6364The following ACL flags are currently supported :
6365
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006366 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
6367 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006368 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
6369
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006370The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
6371specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
6372possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02006373multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
6374be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
6375needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
6376space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
6377match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
6378lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
6379duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
6380to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
6381instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006382
6383 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
6384
6385In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
6386the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
6387case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
6388too.
6389
6390Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
6391a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
6392ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
6393
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006394Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006395
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006396 - integers or integer ranges
6397 - strings
6398 - regular expressions
6399 - IP addresses and networks
6400
6401
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020064027.1. Matching integers
6403----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006404
6405Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
6406that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
6407expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
6408may be omitted.
6409
6410For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
6411unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
6412representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
6413
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006414As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
6415two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
6416instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
6417ranges and operators.
6418
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006419For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006420operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
6421Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
6422of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006423
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006424Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006425
6426 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
6427 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
6428 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
6429 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
6430 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
6431
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006432For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006433
6434 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
6435
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006436This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
6437
6438 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
6439
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006440
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020064417.2. Matching strings
6442---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006443
6444String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
6445exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
6446characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
6447string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
6448to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006449before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006450
6451
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020064527.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
6453-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006454
6455Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
6456they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
6457possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
6458passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
6459the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006460the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
6461match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006462
6463
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020064647.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
6465----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006466
6467IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
6468netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
6469within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006470host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006471difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
6472at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
6473does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
6474parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006475
6476
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020064777.5. Available matching criteria
6478--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006479
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020064807.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
6481------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006482
6483A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
6484analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
6485addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
6486
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006487always_false
6488 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
6489 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
6490
6491always_true
6492 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
6493 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
6494
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006495avg_queue <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02006496avg_queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006497 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
6498 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
6499 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
6500 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
6501 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
6502 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
6503 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
6504 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
6505 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
6506 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
6507 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01006508
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006509be_conn <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02006510be_conn(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006511 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
6512 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
6513 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
6514 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
6515 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006516
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006517be_sess_rate <integer>
6518be_sess_rate(backend) <integer>
6519 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
6520 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
6521 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
6522 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
6523 sucking of an online dictionary).
6524
6525 Example :
6526 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
6527 backend dynamic
6528 mode http
6529 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
6530 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006531
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006532connslots <integer>
6533connslots(backend) <integer>
6534 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006535 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006536 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
6537
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006538 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
6539 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006540
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006541 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006542 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
6543 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
6544 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
6545 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
6546 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006547 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006548
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006549 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
6550 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
6551 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
6552 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006553
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006554dst <ip_address>
6555 Applies to the local IPv4 address the client connected to. It can be used to
6556 switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006557
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006558dst_conn <integer>
6559 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
6560 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
6561 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
6562 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
6563 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
6564 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
6565
6566dst_port <integer>
6567 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
6568 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
6569
6570fe_conn <integer>
6571fe_conn(frontend) <integer>
6572 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
6573 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
6574 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
6575 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
6576 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
6577 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
6578 criteria.
6579
6580fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006581 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006582 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006583
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01006584fe_sess_rate <integer>
6585fe_sess_rate(frontend) <integer>
6586 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
6587 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
6588 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
6589 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
6590 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
6591 the rate to go down below the limit.
6592
6593 Example :
6594 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
6595 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
6596 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
6597 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
6598 frontend mail
6599 bind :25
6600 mode tcp
6601 maxconn 100
6602 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
6603 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
6604 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
6605 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006606
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006607nbsrv <integer>
6608nbsrv(backend) <integer>
6609 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
6610 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
6611 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
6612 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
6613 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01006614
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006615queue <integer>
Willy Tarreauf5a526f2010-09-01 08:06:18 +02006616queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006617 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
6618 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
6619 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
6620 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
6621 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
6622 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
6623 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
6624
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006625sc1_bytes_in_rate
6626sc2_bytes_in_rate
6627 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
6628 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
6629 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
6630
6631sc1_bytes_out_rate
6632sc2_bytes_out_rate
6633 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
6634 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
6635 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
6636
6637sc1_conn_cnt
6638sc2_conn_cnt
6639 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
6640 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
6641
6642sc1_conn_cur
6643sc2_conn_cur
6644 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
6645 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
6646 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
6647
6648sc1_conn_rate
6649sc2_conn_rate
6650 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
6651 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
6652 See also src_conn_rate.
6653
6654sc1_get_gpc0
6655sc2_get_gpc0
6656 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
6657 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
6658
6659sc1_http_err_cnt
6660sc2_http_err_cnt
6661 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
6662 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
6663 See also src_http_err_cnt.
6664
6665sc1_http_err_rate
6666sc2_http_err_rate
6667 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
6668 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
6669 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
6670 src_http_err_rate.
6671
6672sc1_http_req_cnt
6673sc2_http_req_cnt
6674 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
6675 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
6676 src_http_req_cnt.
6677
6678sc1_http_req_rate
6679sc2_http_req_rate
6680 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
6681 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
6682 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
6683 src_http_req_rate.
6684
6685sc1_inc_gpc0
6686sc2_inc_gpc0
6687 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
6688 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
6689 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
6690 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
6691 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
6692 when a first ACL was verified :
6693
6694 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
6695 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
6696 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
6697
6698sc1_kbytes_in
6699sc2_kbytes_in
6700 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
6701 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
6702 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
6703 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
6704
6705sc1_kbytes_out
6706sc2_kbytes_out
6707 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
6708 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
6709 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
6710 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
6711
6712sc1_sess_cnt
6713sc2_sess_cnt
6714 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
6715 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
6716 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
6717 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
6718 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
6719 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
6720
6721sc1_sess_rate
6722sc2_sess_rate
6723 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
6724 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
6725 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
6726 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
6727 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
6728 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
6729
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006730so_id <integer>
6731 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
6732
6733src <ip_address>
6734 Applies to the client's IPv4 address. It is usually used to limit access to
6735 certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level source
6736 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
6737
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006738src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
6739src_bytes_in_rate(table) <integer>
6740 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
6741 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
6742 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006743 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006744
6745src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
6746src_bytes_out_rate(table) <integer>
6747 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
6748 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
6749 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006750 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006751
6752src_conn_cnt <integer>
6753src_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
6754 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
6755 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
6756 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006757 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006758
6759src_conn_cur <integer>
6760src_conn_cur(table) <integer>
6761 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
6762 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
6763 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006764 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006765
6766src_conn_rate <integer>
6767src_conn_rate(table) <integer>
6768 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
6769 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
6770 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006771 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006772
6773src_get_gpc0 <integer>
6774src_get_gpc0(table) <integer>
6775 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
6776 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
6777 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006778 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006779
6780src_http_err_cnt <integer>
6781src_http_err_cnt(table) <integer>
6782 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
6783 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
6784 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006785 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006786
6787src_http_err_rate <integer>
6788src_http_err_rate(table) <integer>
6789 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
6790 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
6791 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
6792 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006793 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006794
6795src_http_req_cnt <integer>
6796src_http_req_cnt(table) <integer>
6797 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
6798 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
6799 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006800 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006801
6802src_http_req_rate <integer>
6803src_http_req_rate(table) <integer>
6804 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
6805 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
6806 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
6807 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006808 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006809
6810src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
6811src_inc_gpc0(table) <integer>
6812 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
6813 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
6814 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
6815 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
6816 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
6817 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
6818
6819 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
6820 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006821 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006822
6823src_kbytes_in <integer>
6824src_kbytes_in(table) <integer>
6825 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
6826 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
6827 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
6828 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006829 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006830
6831src_kbytes_out <integer>
6832src_kbytes_out(table) <integer>
6833 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
6834 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
6835 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
6836 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006837 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02006838
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006839src_port <integer>
6840 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01006841
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006842src_sess_cnt <integer>
6843src_sess_cnt(table) <integer>
6844 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
6845 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
6846 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
6847 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006848 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006849
6850src_sess_rate <integer>
6851src_sess_rate(table) <integer>
6852 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
6853 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
6854 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
6855 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006856 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006857
6858src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
6859src_updt_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02006860 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006861 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
6862 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02006863 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
6864 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
6865 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006866 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02006867
6868 Example :
6869 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
6870 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
6871 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
6872 listen ssh
6873 bind :22
6874 mode tcp
6875 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006876 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02006877 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
6878 server local 127.0.0.1:22
6879
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02006880srv_is_up(<server>)
6881srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
6882 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
6883 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
6884 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
6885 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
6886 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
6887 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
6888 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
6889 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
6890
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006891
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020068927.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
6893---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006894
6895A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
6896during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006897through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
6898keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006899
6900req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02006901 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006902 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
6903 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
6904 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
6905 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
6906 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
6907 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
6908
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02006909req_proto_http
6910 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
6911 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006912 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02006913 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
6914 using TCP request content inspection rules.
6915
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02006916req_rdp_cookie <string>
6917req_rdp_cookie(name) <string>
6918 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
6919 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
6920 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
6921 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
6922 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
6923 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
6924 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
6925 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
6926
6927req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
6928req_rdp_cookie_cnt(name) <integer>
6929 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
6930 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
6931 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
6932 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
6933 cookies.
6934
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006935req_ssl_ver <decimal>
6936 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
6937 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
6938 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
6939 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
6940 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
6941 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
6942 with TCP request content inspection.
6943
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02006944wait_end
6945 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
6946 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
6947 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
6948 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
6949 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
6950 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
6951 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
6952 inspection.
6953
6954 Examples :
6955 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
6956 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
6957 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
6958
6959 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
6960 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
6961 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
6962 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
6963 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
6964 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
6965 tcp-request content reject
6966
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069687.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
6969--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006970
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006971A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006972application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
6973read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
6974than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
6975
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006976hdr <string>
6977hdr(header) <string>
6978 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
6979 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
6980 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
6981 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
6982 Use the shdr() variant for response headers sent by the server.
6983
6984 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
6985 match any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For
6986 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
6987
6988 hdr(Connection) -i close
6989
6990hdr_beg <string>
6991hdr_beg(header) <string>
6992 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
6993 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
6994 response headers sent by the server.
6995
6996hdr_cnt <integer>
6997hdr_cnt(header) <integer>
6998 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
6999 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
7000 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
7001 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
7002 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
7003 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
7004 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7005
7006hdr_dir <string>
7007hdr_dir(header) <string>
7008 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7009 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7010 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
7011 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
7012 headers sent by the server.
7013
7014hdr_dom <string>
7015hdr_dom(header) <string>
7016 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7017 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
7018 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
7019 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
7020 server.
7021
7022hdr_end <string>
7023hdr_end(header) <string>
7024 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
7025 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
7026 response headers sent by the server.
7027
7028hdr_ip <ip_address>
7029hdr_ip(header) <ip_address>
7030 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IP address matching
7031 <ip_address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For or
7032 X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7033 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7034
7035hdr_reg <regex>
7036hdr_reg(header) <regex>
7037 Returns true when one of the headers matches of the regular expressions. It
7038 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
7039 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
7040 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
7041 response headers sent by the server.
7042
7043hdr_sub <string>
7044hdr_sub(header) <string>
7045 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
7046 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
7047 response headers sent by the server.
7048
7049hdr_val <integer>
7050hdr_val(header) <integer>
7051 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
7052 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
7053 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
7054 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7055
7056http_auth(userlist)
7057http_auth_group(userlist) <group> [<group>]*
7058 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
7059 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
7060 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
7061 of specified groups.
7062
7063 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
7064
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007065method <string>
7066 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
7067 already check for most common methods.
7068
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007069path <string>
7070 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
7071 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
7072 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
7073
7074path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007075 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
7076 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007077
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007078path_dir <string>
7079 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7080 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7081 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7082 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
7083
7084path_dom <string>
7085 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7086 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
7087 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
7088
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007089path_end <string>
7090 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
7091 control file name extension.
7092
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007093path_reg <regex>
7094 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7095 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7096 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
7097
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007098path_sub <string>
7099 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7100 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
7101 "path_dir".
7102
7103req_ver <string>
7104 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
7105 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
7106
7107status <integer>
7108 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
7109 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
7110 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
7111
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007112url <string>
7113 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
7114 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL.
7115
7116url_beg <string>
7117 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
7118 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme.
7119
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007120url_dir <string>
7121 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7122 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7123 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7124 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
7125
7126url_dom <string>
7127 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7128 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
7129 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
7130
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007131url_end <string>
7132 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
7133 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007134
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007135url_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007136 Applies to the IP address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request.
7137 It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local network.
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007138 It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007139
7140url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007141 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
7142 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007143 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007144 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007145
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007146url_reg <regex>
7147 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7148 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7149 than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007150
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007151url_sub <string>
7152 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7153 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007154
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007155
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071567.6. Pre-defined ACLs
7157---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007158
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007159Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
7160every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007161order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007163ACL name Equivalent to Usage
7164---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007165FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007166HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007167HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
7168HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007169HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
7170HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
7171HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
7172HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
7173LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007174METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
7175METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
7176METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
7177METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
7178METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
7179METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007180RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007181REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007182TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007183WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
7184---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007185
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071877.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
7188----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007189
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007190Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
7191combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007192
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007193 - AND (implicit)
7194 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
7195 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007196
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007197A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007199 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007200
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007201Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
7202indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007203
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007204For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
7205"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
7206requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
7207is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007209 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7210 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
7211 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
7212 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007214To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
7215and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007216
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007217 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7218 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7219 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
7220 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007221
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007222 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
7223 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
7224 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
7225 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007226
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01007227It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
7228expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
7229be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
7230the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
7231
7232 The following rule :
7233
7234 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7235 block if METH_POST missing_cl
7236
7237 Can also be written that way :
7238
7239 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
7240
7241It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
7242to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
7243simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
7244sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
7245good use is the following :
7246
7247 With named ACLs :
7248
7249 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7250 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7251 monitor fail if site_dead
7252
7253 With anonymous ACLs :
7254
7255 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
7256
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007257See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007258
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01007259
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010072607.8. Pattern extraction
7261-----------------------
7262
7263The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
7264response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
7265for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
7266
7267All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
7268"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
7269begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
7270arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
7271much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
7272equivalent used in ACLs.
7273
7274The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
7275
7276 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
7277 It is of type IP and only works with such tables.
7278
7279 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
7280 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
7281 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
7282 typie IP and only works with such tables.
7283
7284 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
7285 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
7286 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
7287 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
7288 type integer and only works with such tables.
7289
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02007290 hdr(name) This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
7291 request and converts it to an IP address. This IP address is
7292 then used to match the table. A typical use is with the
7293 x-forwarded-for header.
7294
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007295
7296The currently available list of transformations include :
7297
7298 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
7299 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7300 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7301
7302 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
7303 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7304 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7305
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01007306 ipmask(mask) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
7307 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
7308 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
7309 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
7310 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
7311
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007312
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073138. Logging
7314----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007315
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007316One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
7317provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
7318very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
7319provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
7320state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007321to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007322headers.
7323
7324In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
7325about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
7326send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
7327
7328 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
7329 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
7330 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
7331 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
7332 at the termination.
7333
7334The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
7335allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
7336as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
7337while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
7338real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
7339delay.
7340
7341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073428.1. Log levels
7343---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007344
7345TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with informations such as date, time,
7346source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
7347HTTP request, the HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, the conditions
7348in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values, to track a
7349particular user's problems for example. All messages are sent to up to two
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007350syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more info about log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007351facilities.
7352
7353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073548.2. Log formats
7355----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007356
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007357HAProxy supports 4 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007358and will be detailed in the next sections. A few of them may slightly vary with
7359the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain options. The supported
7360formats are the following ones :
7361
7362 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
7363 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
7364 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
7365 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
7366 extents.
7367
7368 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
7369 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
7370 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
7371 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
7372 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
7373
7374 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
7375 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
7376 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
7377 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
7378 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
7379
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007380 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
7381 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
7382 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
7383 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
7384
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007385Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
7386specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
7387field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
7388servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
7389always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
7390identifier.
7391
7392Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
7393 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
7394 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
7395 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
7396 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
7397
7398
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073998.2.1. Default log format
7400-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007401
7402This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
7403as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
7404format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
7405
7406 Example :
7407 listen www
7408 mode http
7409 log global
7410 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7411
7412 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
7413 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
7414 (www/HTTP)
7415
7416 Field Format Extract from the example above
7417 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
7418 2 'Connect from' Connect from
7419 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
7420 4 'to' to
7421 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
7422 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
7423
7424Detailed fields description :
7425 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
7426 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
7427 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
7428 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
7429 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
7430 and processed the connection.
7431 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
7432
7433It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
7434will eventually disappear.
7435
7436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074378.2.2. TCP log format
7438---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007439
7440The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
7441is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
7442information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
7443counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
7444emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
7445environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
7446the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
7447sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007448specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
7449not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
7450fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
7451marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007452
7453 Example :
7454 frontend fnt
7455 mode tcp
7456 option tcplog
7457 log global
7458 default_backend bck
7459
7460 backend bck
7461 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7462
7463 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
7464 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
7465 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
7466
7467 Field Format Extract from the example above
7468 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
7469 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
7470 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
7471 4 frontend_name fnt
7472 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
7473 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
7474 7 bytes_read* 212
7475 8 termination_state --
7476 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
7477 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
7478
7479Detailed fields description :
7480 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
7481 connection to haproxy.
7482
7483 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
7484
7485 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
7486 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
7487 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
7488 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
7489
7490 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
7491 and processed the connection.
7492
7493 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
7494 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
7495 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
7496 applications.
7497
7498 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
7499 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
7500 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
7501 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
7502 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
7503
7504 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
7505 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
7506 See "Timers" below for more details.
7507
7508 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
7509 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
7510 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
7511 "Timers" below for more details.
7512
7513 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
7514 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
7515 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
7516 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
7517 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
7518 details.
7519
7520 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
7521 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
7522 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
7523 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
7524 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
7525
7526 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
7527 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
7528 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
7529 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
7530 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
7531 for more details.
7532
7533 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
7534 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
7535 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
7536 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
7537 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007538 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007539
7540 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
7541 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
7542 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
7543 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
7544 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
7545 caused by a denial of service attack.
7546
7547 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
7548 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
7549 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
7550 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
7551 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
7552 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
7553 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
7554 denial of service attack.
7555
7556 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
7557 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
7558 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
7559 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
7560 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
7561 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
7562 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
7563 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
7564 be processed than on other servers.
7565
7566 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
7567 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
7568 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
7569 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
7570 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
7571 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
7572 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
7573 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
7574 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
7575 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
7576 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
7577 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
7578 should not be attributed to the logged server.
7579
7580 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
7581 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
7582 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
7583 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
7584 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
7585 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
7586 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
7587 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
7588
7589 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
7590 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
7591 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
7592 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
7593 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
7594 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
7595 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
7596 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
7597 occurs.
7598
7599
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020076008.2.3. HTTP log format
7601----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007602
7603The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
7604is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
7605the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
7606are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
7607emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
7608generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
7609"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
7610which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007611frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
7612is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007613
7614Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
7615slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
7616with a star ('*') after the field name below.
7617
7618 Example :
7619 frontend http-in
7620 mode http
7621 option httplog
7622 log global
7623 default_backend bck
7624
7625 backend static
7626 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7627
7628 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7629 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7630 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007631 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007632
7633 Field Format Extract from the example above
7634 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
7635 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
7636 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
7637 4 frontend_name http-in
7638 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
7639 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
7640 7 status_code 200
7641 8 bytes_read* 2750
7642 9 captured_request_cookie -
7643 10 captured_response_cookie -
7644 11 termination_state ----
7645 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
7646 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
7647 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
7648 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
7649 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007650
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007651
7652Detailed fields description :
7653 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
7654 connection to haproxy.
7655
7656 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
7657
7658 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
7659 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
7660 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
7661 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
7662 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
7663
7664 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
7665 and processed the connection.
7666
7667 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
7668 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
7669 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
7670
7671 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
7672 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
7673 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
7674 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
7675 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
7676 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
7677
7678 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
7679 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
7680 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
7681 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
7682 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
7683 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
7684
7685 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
7686 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
7687 See "Timers" below for more details.
7688
7689 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
7690 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
7691 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
7692 below for more details.
7693
7694 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
7695 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
7696 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
7697 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
7698 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
7699 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
7700 for more details.
7701
7702 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
7703 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
7704 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
7705 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
7706 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
7707 details.
7708
7709 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
7710 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
7711 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
7712
7713 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
7714 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
7715 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
7716 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
7717 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
7718 overflowing.
7719
7720 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
7721 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
7722 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
7723 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
7724 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
7725 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
7726 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
7727 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
7728
7729 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
7730 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
7731 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
7732 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
7733 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
7734 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
7735 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
7736 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
7737
7738 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
7739 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
7740 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
7741 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
7742 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
7743 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
7744 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
7745
7746 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
7747 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
7748 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
7749 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
7750 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007751 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007752 system.
7753
7754 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
7755 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
7756 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
7757 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
7758 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
7759 caused by a denial of service attack.
7760
7761 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
7762 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
7763 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
7764 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
7765 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
7766 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
7767 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
7768 denial of service attack.
7769
7770 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
7771 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
7772 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
7773 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
7774 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
7775 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
7776 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
7777 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
7778 processed than on other servers.
7779
7780 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
7781 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
7782 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
7783 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
7784 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
7785 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
7786 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
7787 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
7788 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
7789 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
7790 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
7791 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
7792 should not be attributed to the logged server.
7793
7794 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
7795 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
7796 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
7797 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
7798 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
7799 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
7800 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
7801 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
7802
7803 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
7804 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
7805 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
7806 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
7807 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
7808 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
7809 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
7810 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
7811 occurs.
7812
7813 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
7814 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
7815 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
7816 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
7817 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
7818 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
7819 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
7820 cookies" below for more details.
7821
7822 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
7823 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
7824 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
7825 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
7826 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
7827 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
7828 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
7829 and cookies" below for more details.
7830
7831 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
7832 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
7833 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
7834 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
7835 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
7836 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
7837 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
7838 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
7839
7840
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078418.3. Advanced logging options
7842-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007843
7844Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
7845just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
7846options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
7847for more information about their usage.
7848
7849
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078508.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
7851------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007852
7853It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
7854haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
7855commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
7856monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
7857ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
7858
7859 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
7860 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
7861 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
7862 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
7863
7864 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
7865 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
7866 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
7867 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
7868 such as other load-balancers.
7869
7870 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
7871 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
7872 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
7873
7874
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078758.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
7876----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007877
7878The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
7879what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
7880or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
7881"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
7882just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
7883log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
7884after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
7885is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
7886with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
7887with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
7888
7889
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078908.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
7891------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007892
7893Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
7894for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
7895"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
7896retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
7897raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
7898a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
7899file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
7900you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
7901"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
7902
7903
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079048.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
7905--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007906
7907Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
7908multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
7909them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
7910"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
7911logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
7912error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
7913and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
7914too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
7915useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
7916alternative.
7917
7918
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079198.4. Timing events
7920------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007921
7922Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
7923reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
7924the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
7925frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
7926mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
7927
7928 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
7929 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
7930 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
7931 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
7932 the client closes prematurely or times out.
7933
7934 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
7935 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
7936 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
7937 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
7938 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
7939
7940 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
7941 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
7942 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
7943 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
7944 connection never established.
7945
7946 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
7947 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
7948 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
7949 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
7950 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
7951 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
7952 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
7953 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
7954 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
7955 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
7956 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
7957
7958 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
7959 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
7960 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
7961 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
7962 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
7963
7964 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
7965
7966 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
7967 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
7968 negative.
7969
7970These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
7971protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
7972that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007973due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007974close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
7975session has been aborted on timeout.
7976
7977Most common cases :
7978
7979 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
7980 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
7981 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
7982 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
7983 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
7984 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
7985 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
7986 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
7987 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02007988 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
7989 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
7990 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007991
7992 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
7993 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
7994 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
7995 of ms on remote networks.
7996
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007997 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
7998 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
7999 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008000
8001 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
8002 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
8003 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
8004 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
8005 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
8006 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
8007 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
8008 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
8009 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
8010 to the server until another one is released.
8011
8012Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
8013
8014 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
8015 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
8016 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
8017
8018 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
8019 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
8020 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
8021
8022 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
8023 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
8024 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
8025 flags.
8026
8027 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
8028 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
8029 Check the session termination flags, then check the
8030 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
8031 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
8032 the client connection was maintained open.
8033
8034 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
8035 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
8036 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
8037 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
8038
8039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020080408.5. Session state at disconnection
8041-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008042
8043TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
8044"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
80452-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
8046each of which has a special meaning :
8047
8048 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
8049 session to terminate :
8050
8051 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
8052
8053 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
8054 server explicitly refused it.
8055
8056 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
8057 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
8058 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
8059 error in server response which might have caused information leak
8060 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
8061 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
8062
8063 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
8064 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
8065 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
8066 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
8067 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
8068
8069 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
8070 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
8071 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
8072 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
8073 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
8074
8075 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
8076 send or receive data.
8077
8078 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
8079 send or receive data.
8080
8081 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
8082 with nothing left in the buffers.
8083
8084 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
8085
8086 R : th proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
8087 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
8088
8089 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
8090 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
8091 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
8092 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
8093 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
8094
8095 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
8096 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
8097
8098 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
8099 server (HTTP only).
8100
8101 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
8102
8103 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
8104 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
8105 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
8106
8107 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
8108 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
8109 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
8110
8111 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
8112
8113 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
8114 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
8115
8116 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
8117 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
8118 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
8119
8120 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
8121 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02008122 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
8123 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008124
8125 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
8126 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
8127 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
8128 another server.
8129
8130 V : the client provided a valid cookie, and was sent to the associated
8131 server.
8132
8133 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8134
8135 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
8136 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
8137
8138 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
8139
8140 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
8141 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
8142 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
8143
8144 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
8145
8146 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
8147 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
8148
8149 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
8150
8151 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8152
8153The combination of the two first flags give a lot of information about what was
8154happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
8155helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
8156starvation, attacks, etc...
8157
8158The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
8159alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
8160easier finding and understanding.
8161
8162 Flags Reason
8163
8164 -- Normal termination.
8165
8166 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
8167 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
8168 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
8169 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
8170
8171 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
8172 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
8173 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
8174 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
8175 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
8176 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008177
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008178 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8179 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
8180 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
8181
8182 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
8183 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
8184 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
8185
8186 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
8187 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
8188 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
8189 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
8190 the server takes too long to respond.
8191
8192 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
8193 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
8194 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
8195 long a time to respond.
8196
8197 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
8198 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
8199 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
8200 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
8201 and the client.
8202
8203 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
8204 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
8205 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
8206 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
8207 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
8208 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
8209
8210 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
8211 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008212 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
8213 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
8214 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
8215 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008216
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008217 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008218 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
8219 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
8220 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
8221 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
8222 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
8223
8224 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
8225 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
8226 503 or 504 here.
8227
8228 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
8229 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
8230 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
8231 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
8232 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
8233
8234 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8235 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008236 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008237 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
8238 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
8239
8240 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
8241 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
8242 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
8243 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
8244 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
8245 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
8246 between haproxy and the server.
8247
8248 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
8249 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
8250 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
8251 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
8252 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
8253 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
8254 solution is to fix the application.
8255
8256 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
8257 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
8258 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
8259 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
8260 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
8261 external attacks.
8262
8263 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
8264 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
8265 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
8266 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
8267 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
8268
8269 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
8270 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
8271 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
8272 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
8273 containing unauthorized characters.
8274
8275 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
8276 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
8277 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
8278 returned an HTTP 403 error.
8279
8280 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
8281 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
8282 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
8283 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
8284
8285 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
8286 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
8287 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
8288 only be solved by proper system tuning.
8289
8290
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020082918.6. Non-printable characters
8292-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008293
8294In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
8295consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
8296converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
8297prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
8298being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
8299escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
8300is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
8301'}' when logging headers.
8302
8303Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
8304issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
8305containing spaces is "User-Agent".
8306
8307Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
8308the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
8309performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
8310
8311
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
8313---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008314
8315Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
8316achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008317section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008318cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
8319the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
8320the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008321locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008322not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
8323user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
8324a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
8325wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
8326
8327 Examples :
8328 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
8329 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
8330
8331 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
8332 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
8333
8334
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083358.8. Capturing HTTP headers
8336---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008337
8338Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
8339proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
8340the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
8341server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
8342
8343Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
8344response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008345section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008346
8347It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008348time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
8349appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008350are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
8351and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
8352follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
8353request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
8354in the logs.
8355
8356 Example :
8357 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
8358 listen proxy-out
8359 mode http
8360 option httplog
8361 option logasap
8362 log global
8363 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
8364
8365 # log the name of the virtual server
8366 capture request header Host len 20
8367
8368 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
8369 capture request header Content-Length len 10
8370
8371 # log the beginning of the referrer
8372 capture request header Referer len 20
8373
8374 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
8375 capture response header Server len 20
8376
8377 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
8378 capture response header Content-Length len 10
8379
8380 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
8381 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
8382
8383 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
8384 capture response header Via len 20
8385
8386 # log the URL location during a redirection
8387 capture response header Location len 20
8388
8389 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
8390 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
8391 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8392 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
8393 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
8394
8395 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
8396 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
8397 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8398 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008399 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008400
8401 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
8402 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
8403 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8404 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
8405 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008406 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008407
8408
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084098.9. Examples of logs
8410---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008411
8412These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
8413them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
8414reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
8415
8416 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
8417 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
8418 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
8419
8420 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
8421 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
8422
8423 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
8424 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
8425 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
8426
8427 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
8428 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
8429
8430 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
8431 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
8432 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8433
8434 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008435 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008436 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
8437 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
8438
8439 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
8440 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
8441 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
8442
8443 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
8444 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
8445 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensible information which
8446 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
8447 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
8448 to return the 502 and not the server.
8449
8450 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008451 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008452
8453 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
8454 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
8455 Nothing was sent to any server.
8456
8457 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
8458 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
8459
8460 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
8461 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
8462 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
8463 send a 408 return code to the client.
8464
8465 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
8466 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
8467
8468 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
8469 5 seconds ("c----").
8470
8471 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
8472 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008473 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008474
8475 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008476 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008477 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
8478 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
8479 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
8480 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
8481 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008482
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008483
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084849. Statistics and monitoring
8485----------------------------
8486
8487It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
8488mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
8489CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
8490Unix socket.
8491
8492
84939.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008494---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008495
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +01008496The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
8497page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
8498
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008499 0. pxname: proxy name
8500 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
8501 for server)
8502 2. qcur: current queued requests
8503 3. qmax: max queued requests
8504 4. scur: current sessions
8505 5. smax: max sessions
8506 6. slim: sessions limit
8507 7. stot: total sessions
8508 8. bin: bytes in
8509 9. bout: bytes out
8510 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01008511 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008512 12. ereq: request errors
8513 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01008514 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008515 15. wretr: retries (warning)
8516 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +01008517 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008518 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
8519 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
8520 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
8521 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
8522 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
8523 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
8524 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
8525 25. qlimit: queue limit
8526 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
8527 27. iid: unique proxy id
8528 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
8529 29. throttle: warm up status
8530 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
8531 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008532 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +02008533 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
8534 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
8535 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02008536 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008537 UNK -> unknown
8538 INI -> initializing
8539 SOCKERR -> socket error
8540 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
8541 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
8542 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
8543 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
8544 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
8545 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
8546 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
8547 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
8548 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
8549 disable-on-404
8550 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
8551 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
8552 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02008553 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
8554 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008555 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
8556 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
8557 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
8558 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
8559 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
8560 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008561 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
8562 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
8563 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
8564 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01008565 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
8566 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008567
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008568
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085699.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008570-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01008571
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008572The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008573must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
8574is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
8575a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
8576risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
8577followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
8578given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
8579then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
8580to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008581
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008582It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
8583on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
8584own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008585
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008586clear counters
8587 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
8588 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
8589 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
8590 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
8591 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
8592
8593clear counters all
8594 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
8595 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
8596 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
8597
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008598clear table <table> key <key>
8599 Remove entry <key> from the stick-table <table>. The key must be of the same
8600 type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4. This is typically used
8601 un unblock some users complaining they have been abusively denied access to a
8602 service, but this can also be used to clear some stickiness entries matching
8603 a server that is going to be replaced (see "show table" below for details).
8604 Note that sometimes, removal of a key will be refused because it is currently
8605 tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds later after the session ends is
8606 usuall enough.
8607
8608 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008609 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
8610 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
8611 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
8612 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
8613 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
8614 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008615
8616 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
8617
8618 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008619 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:1
8620 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
8621 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008622
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008623disable server <backend>/<server>
8624 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
8625 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
8626 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
8627 during the maintenance.
8628
8629 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
8630 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
8631
8632 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
8633 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
8634
8635 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
8636 level "admin".
8637
8638enable server <backend>/<server>
8639 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
8640 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
8641
8642 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
8643 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
8644
8645 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
8646 level "admin".
8647
8648get weight <backend>/<server>
8649 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
8650 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
8651 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
8652 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
8653 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
8654 dash ('#').
8655
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008656help
8657 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
8658 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008659
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008660prompt
8661 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
8662 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
8663 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
8664 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
8665 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
8666 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
8667 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
8668 command.
8669
8670quit
8671 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01008672
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008673set timeout cli <delay>
8674 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
8675 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
8676 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
8677
8678set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
8679 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
8680 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
8681 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
8682 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
8683 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
8684 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
8685 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
8686 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
8687 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
8688 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
8689 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
8690 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
8691 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
8692 numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
8693
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01008694show errors [<iid>]
8695 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
8696 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02008697 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
8698 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
8699 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01008700
8701 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
8702 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
8703 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
8704 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
8705 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
8706 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
8707 are reported too.
8708
8709 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
8710 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
8711 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
8712 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
8713 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
8714 code.
8715
8716 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
8717 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
8718 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
8719 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
8720 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
8721 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
8722 line.
8723
8724 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008725 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
8726 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01008727 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
8728 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
8729
8730 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
8731 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
8732 00038 Location: blah\r\n
8733 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
8734 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
8735 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
8736 00204+ minal\r\n
8737 00211 \r\n
8738
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008739 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01008740 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
8741 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
8742 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
8743 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
8744 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
8745 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01008746
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008747show info
8748 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
8749
8750show sess
8751 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02008752 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
8753 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
8754
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +01008755show sess <id>
8756 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
8757 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
8758 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
8759 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
8760 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
8761 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008762
8763show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
8764 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
8765 possible to dump only selected items :
8766 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
8767 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
8768 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
8769 for example:
8770 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
8771 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
8772 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
8773
8774 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008775 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
8776 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008777 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
8778 Release_date: 2009/09/23
8779 Nbproc: 1
8780 Process_num: 1
8781 (...)
8782
8783 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
8784 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
8785 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
8786 (...)
8787 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
8788
8789 $
8790
8791 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
8792 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
8793 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
8794 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008795 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008796
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008797show table
8798 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
8799 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
8800 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
8801 entries currently in use.
8802
8803 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008804 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
8805 >>> # table: front_pub, type: 0, size:204800, used:171454
8806 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: 0, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008807
8808show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ]
8809 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
8810 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
8811 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
8812 a filter in order to specify what entries to display. The filter then applies
8813 to the stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2). One stored data type
8814 has to be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table
8815 otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator>
8816 with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
8817 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
8818 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
8819 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
8820 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
8821 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
8822 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
8823
8824 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008825 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
8826 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
8827 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
8828 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
8829 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
8830 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008831
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008832 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
8833 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
8834 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
8835 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008836
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008837 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
8838 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
8839 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
8840 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
8841 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008842
8843 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
8844 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
8845 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
8846 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
8847 time goes, the average event rate drops.
8848
8849 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
8850 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
8851 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008852 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
8853 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008854 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
8855 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +02008856
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008857/*
8858 * Local variables:
8859 * fill-column: 79
8860 * End:
8861 */